You are on page 1of 72

TOHNICHI

Professional Torque Product Catalog

2016
Your Torque Partner
Through advances in torque technology, Tohnichi contributes to the
creation of a safer world by helping to obtain the highest level of product
safety in transportation, information technology, and many other fields
that affect our daily lives.

TORQUE CENTER
A wide variety of services available including: theoretical information, application
assistance, training seminars, and testing facilities.

Laboratory
Visitors can use this space.
Actual work piece is carried in and
proper tightening torque can be
measured.

Showroom
Tohnichi torque products are
set-up and displayed so that visitor
can have a clear look on what is
available on the torque market and
what will be coming up soon.

Lecture room
Various courses of torque
engineering seminars are available.

Training room
Our customers can attend
workshops, covering a global
training, general repair and
adjustment on torque products.
Tohnichi Torque Center in Tokyo

The above facilities and services are available at Tokyo, Osaka, Nagoya in Japan, Tohnichi
Shanghai in China, Tohnichi Europe in Belgium, and Tohnichi America in Chicago.
Contents

Selection of Torque
How to Select Torque Products ················································· 2
From Torque Control to Tightening Assurance System ············ 4 Torque Wrench for Quality Inspection

Products
CEM3-G ––––––––––––– DATA TORK/Digital Torque Wrench ··················· 36
Torque Screwdriver CEM3-P ––––––––––––– DATA TORK/Programmable Digital Torque Wrench ··· 36
CTB2-G–––––––––––––– Digital Retightening Torque Wrench ··················· 37
RTD –––––––––––––––––– Rotary Slip Adjustable Torque Screwdriver ··········· 6 DB/DBE/DBR ––––––– Dial Indicating Torque Wrench ························· 38
LTD –––––––––––––––––– Adjustable Torque Screwdriver ·························· 6 CDB-S ––––––––––––––– Interchangeable Head Type Dial Indicating Torque Wrench ·· 39
RNTD –––––––––––––––– Rotary Slip Preset Torque Screwdriver ················· 7 SCDB-S ––––––––––––– European Style Interchangeable
NTD –––––––––––––––––– Preset Torque Screwdriver ································ 7 Head Type Dial Indicating Torque Wrench··········· 39
RTDZ –––––––––––––––– Insulated Rotary Slip Adjustable Torque Screwdriver ··· 7 T-S ––––––––––––––––––– T-Handle Dial Indicating Torque Wrench ············· 39
RNTDZ –––––––––––––– Insulated Rotary Slip Preset Torque Screwdriver ···· 7 SF/F/FR ––––––––––––– Beam Type Torque Wrench ····························· 40
AMRD/BMRD ––––––– Rotary Slip Adjustable Torque Screwdriver for Small Screws ····· 8 CSF/CF –––––––––––––– Interchangeable Head Type Beam Type Torque Wrench ······ 40
AMLD/BMLD –––––––– Adjustable Torque Screwdriver for Small Screws ····· 8 QF/QFR ––––––––––––– Ratchet Head Beam Type Torque Wrench··········· 40
MNTD–––––––––––––––– Marking Torque Screwdriver ······························ 9 Interchangeable Socket ···························································· 41
RTDLS/RNTDLS –––– Rotary Slip Type Torque Screwdriver with Limit Switch ····· 9
RTDFH/RNTDFH –––– Rotary Slip Type Pokayoke Torque Screwdriver ····· 9
FTD –––––––––––––––––– Dial Indicating Torque Screwdriver with Memory Pointer ···· 10 Accessories
MTD ––––––––––––––––– Micro Dial Indicating Torque Screwdriver············ 10 Interchangeable Head ······························································ 42
STC2-G/-BT ––––––––– Digital Torque Screwdriver ······························ 10 Auxiliary Equipment ·································································· 46
Interchangeable Bit ··································································· 11 Connecting Cable ····································································· 47
Quick Charger, Battery Pack, AC Adapter ······························· 47
Torque Wrench for Assembly
QL/QLE2 –––––––––––– Ratchet Head Type Adjustable Torque Wrench ···· 12
Power Torque Tool
QL-MH––––––––––––––– QL with Metal Handle ···································· 12 A/AC2 ––––––––––––––– Semi-Automatic Airtork ·································· 48
CL/CLE2––––––––––––– Interchangeable Head Type Adjustable Torque Wrench······· 13 AUR–––––––––––––––––– UNITORK/Pistol Type Pneumatic Torque Screwdriver ··· 48
CL-MH ––––––––––––––– CL with Metal Handle ···································· 13 HAC–––––––––––––––––– Battery Operated Semi-Automatic Torque Wrench ··· 49
DQL/DQLE2 ––––––––– ········· 14
Dual Square Drives Type Adjustable Torque Wrench HAT –––––––––––––––––– HANDYTORK/Battery Operated Torque Screwdriver ··· 49
TW2–––––––––––––––––– Adjustable Torque Wrench with Multiplier ··········· 14 DU ––––––––––––––––––– Fully-Automatic Electric Torque Screwdriver ······· 50
MTQL –––––––––––––––– Torque Wrench for Motorsports ······················· 14 U/UR––––––––––––––––– UNITORK/Straight & Pistol Pneumatic Torque Screwdriver ··· 50
TiQL/TiQLE –––––––––– Titanium Adjustable Torque Wrench ·················· 15 AP ––––––––––––––––––– Fully-Automatic Airtork ·································· 51
PHL/PHLE2 ––––––––– Pipe-Wrench Head Type Adjustable Torque Wrench ··· 15 DAP –––––––––––––––––– Fully-Automatic Electric Torque Wrench ············· 51
QRSP –––––––––––––––– Open Ring Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ······ 15 ME/MC –––––––––––––– Multiple Unit/Pneumatic Straight Style··············· 52
PQL –––––––––––––––––– Ratchet Head Type Pre-Lock Torque Wrench ······ 16 MG/MF –––––––––––––– Multiple Unit/Pneumatic Straight Style··············· 52
PQLZ –––––––––––––––– Pre-Lock Adjustable Insulated Torque Wrench····· 16
QSPZ –––––––––––––––– Preset Insulated Torque Wrench ······················· 16
MT70N––––––––––––––– Moto Tork/Pre-Lock Specialty Torque Wrench ····· 16
Torque Tester/Checker
PCL –––––––––––––––––– Interchangeable Head Type Pre-Lock Torque Wrench ··· 17
TDT3-G –––––––––––––– Digital Torque Screwdriver Tester ····················· 53
SCL –––––––––––––––––– European Style Interchangeable
DOTE3-G –––––––––––– Digital Torque Wrench Tester ··························· 54
Head Type Adjustable Torque Wrench ··············· 17
DOT –––––––––––––––––– Analog Torque Wrench Tester ·························· 54
SCSP –––––––––––––––– European Style Interchangeable
Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ····················· 17 TF –––––––––––––––––––– Fully Automatic Digital Torque Wrench Tester ······ 55
QSP –––––––––––––––––– Ratchet Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ·········· 18 TCC2-G–––––––––––––– Digital Torque Wrench Tester ··························· 55
QSP-MH ––––––––––––– QSP with Metal Handle ·································· 18 LC3-G ––––––––––––––– Torque Wrench Line Checker··························· 56
BQSP –––––––––––––––– Bi-Directional Type Preset Torque Wrench ·········· 18 ST3-G/-BT –––––––––– SPINTORK/Rotary Peak Torque Meter ··············· 56
CSP –––––––––––––––––– Interchangeable Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ··· 19 ATG/BTG –––––––––––– Analog Torque Gauge ···································· 57
CSP-MH ––––––––––––– CSP with Metal Handle ·································· 19 ATGE-G –––––––––––––– Digital Torque Gauge ····································· 57
BCSP –––––––––––––––– Bi-Directional Interchangeable Head Type BTGE-G ––––––––––––– Digital Torque Gauge ····································· 58
Preset Torque Wrench ··································· 19 TME2 –––––––––––––––– Digital Torque Meter ······································ 59
SP2/-MH –––––––––––– Open End Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ······· 20 TM ––––––––––––––––––– Analog Torque Meter ····································· 59
RSP2/-MH––––––––––– Ring Head Type Preset Torque Wrench················· 20 TCF –––––––––––––––––– Fixed Type Torque Sensor ······························ 60
SP2-H ––––––––––––––– Torque Wrench for Piping Work ························ 21 TCR –––––––––––––––––– Rotary Type Torque Sensor ····························· 60
SP2-N/-MH–––––––––– Notched Head Type Preset Torque Wrench ········· 21 Calibration Kit ··········································································· 61
NSP100CNx8 ––––––– Break-Over Torque Wrench ···························· 21
QSPCA –––––––––––––– Slip Type Torque Wrench ································ 22
YCL2––––––––––––––––– Two Step Motion Torque Wrench ······················ 22
Force Measurement Instrument
CPT-G ––––––––––––––– PRO TORK/Digital Torque Wrench for Tightening ··· 23 BTM/B-BTM –––––––– Bolt Tension Meter ········································ 62
CTA2-G –––––––––––––– Digital Torque and Angle Wrench ······················ 24 Fcon ––––––––––––––––– Bolt Tension Stabilization································ 62
DWQL ––––––––––––––– Analog Torque Wrench with Digital Angle Module ··· 25 TT2000 –––––––––––––– Ultrasonic Tension Meter ································ 63
WQL ––––––––––––––––– Analog Torque and Angle Wrench ····················· 25
MPQL/MQL ––––––––– Marking Preset Torque Wrench ························ 26
MQSP ––––––––––––––– Marking Torque Wrench ································· 26 Optional Equipment
CMQSP –––––––––––––– Marking Torque Wrench for Hex Screws············· 26 CD5 –––––––––––––––––– Compact Display ·········································· 64
MPQL/MQL/MQSP Optional Accessories ······························· 27 R-DT999 ––––––––––––– Data Tank ··················································· 64
Pokayoke, Error-Proofing System ············································ 28 DFS –––––––––––––––––– Data Filing System/CD-ROM ··························· 64
CNA-4mk3 –––––––––– POKA Patrol/Count Checker ··························· 28 EPP16M3–––––––––––– Printer························································ 65
Torque Wrench with Limit Switch ············································· 29 DECA –––––––––––––––– 10:1 Ratio Torque Multiplier ···························· 65
FH256MC ––––––––––– Radio Frequency Torque Wrench System ··········· 30 EVERTORQUE –––––– Lubricant for repair ······································· 65
FMA ––––––––––––––––– Radio Frequency Torque Wrench System ··········· 30
BL –––––––––––––––––––– Battery Less Wireless Torque Wrench ················ 31
Tightening Data Management System Technical Data
CSPD –––––––––––––––– Wired Data Transfer Torque wrench ·················· 32 Torque Settings for Torque Screwdrivers··································· 66
CSPFD/FDD ––––––––– Wireless Data Transfer Torque Wrench ··············· 33
Torque Settings for Torque Wrenches ······································ 67
CEM3-G-BTS/BTD –– Wireless Digital Torque Wrench ························ 34
Torque Conversion List ····························································· 68
TDMS –––––––––––––––– Data Management Software ···························· 35
Standard Tightening Torque ····················································· 69

1
Selection of Torque

How to Select Torque Products


Products

Select the correct Tohnichi product for an application.


FOR TIGHTENING
Tightening bolts at a given torque

QL
TORQUE
Standard model for tightening
WRENCH P.12

FOR INSPECTION
Nominal diameter
Inspecting the torque of tightened bolts
M4-M40
Nominal diameter DB/CDB

Standard model for inspection


P.38

FOR TIGHTENING
Tightening screws at a given torque

RTD/LTD/AMRD/AMLD

TORQUE
Rotary slip torque screwdriver
TORQUE SCREWDRIVER (Over-torque prevention) P.6

PRODUCTS FOR INSPECTION


Nominal diameter Inspecting the torque of
M1.6-M6 tightened screws

FTD-S/FTD

Direct reading type P.10

FOR MEASURING VERY


SMALL TORQUE
Inspecting small torque ranging
from 0.05cN·m-150cN·m

ATG/BTG
with 3-jaw chuck
TORQUE GAUGE/
TORQUE METER P.57

FOR MEASURING CAP


OPENING TORQUE
Measuring torque for For checking torque on bottle caps,
special products starting torque test, and twisting torque, etc.

TM

Analog type P.59


2
Selection of Torque
Products
If other types of head is requested
In such working condition where resin handles are not suitable

CL QL-MH CL-MH

Interchangeable head version of QL P.13 Metal handle version of QL P.12 Metal handle version of CL P.13

If tightening at one particular torque only


If tightening the same bolts at particular torque only

QSP CSP SP2 SP2-MH RSP2 RSP2-MH

Preset version of QL Interchangeable head version of QSP Preset type open end head P.20 Preset type ring head P.20
P.18 P.19

For calibrating torque wrenches


SF/F/QF/CF CEM3-G/CTB2-G
MEASUREMENT 13/8/9 14:00

Serial Number Model Name Ch Accuracy (%) Click Type


TOH000-A12345 CEM100N3X15D 1 3.0
esc

Zero
0.0000 N.m
Set Torque 1 2 3 4 5

Clear 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000

40.000 40.000 44.000 40.000 40.000 40.000

60.000 60.000 60.000 60.000 63.500 60.000


MEMORY 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000

100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00

Beam type P.40 Digital type P.36

TCC2-G DOTE3-G
P.55 P.54

Tightening at one particular torque only

RNTD/NTD For daily inspection of torque wrenches

Preset version of RTD P.7

STC2-G
G
LC3-G Line Checker P.56

Other Torque Wrench Testers:


Digital type P.10 DOT and TF models are also available.

Other Torque Measurement

ST3-G/ TCF / TCR


P.56 P.60

ATGE-G BTGE-G
Example

CL 100 N × 15D
Size of interchangeable head
* Interchangeable head type only

Unit (N = N·m, CN = cN·m, MN = mN·m)


Digital type P.57 Digital type P.58

Torque range (Maximum torque in S.I. unit)

TME2 Model

Please refer to the "Torque Handbook vol. 8"


for further technical information.
Digital type P.59
3
Selection of Torque

From Torque Control to Tightening Assurance System


Products

Tohnichi's Torque Assurance System advises the users how to tighten bolts properly and how to
eliminate various mistakes which occur during bolt tightening operations.

Total Tightening Management System, which completes tightening assurance, will be created
through cooperation of your staffs. Each component and product which consists of the system can
be sold separately. The components and products are described in the catalog.

TOHNICHI TIGHTENING ASSURANCE SYSTEM

Pneumatic Tightening Data Pokayoke S


Management System (Error-Proofing

Fully-Automatic Electric Pneumatic Torque Driver Torque Wrench Remote Signal Type Batt
Multiple Unit Torque Screwdriver with Limit Switch with Limit Switch Torque Wrench T

ME-TC ACLS CSPFH

DU AURLS
RTDFH
MC-TC Wired QLLS
Wireless

RTDLS
Wired
DU-COUNTER

Receiver
Wired Wired R-FH256
Torque Indicator
CD5

Count Checker
Software CNA-4mk3
Tightening Count Con

Tool Management System Inspectio


for Pneumatic Tools Manageme

Periodical Daily
Calibration Inspection Digital Type
Torque Wrench
Rotary Peak CEM3-G-BTS
Torque Sensor Torque Meter Simplex

CTB2-G
TCF+TP
CEM3-G
ST3-G ST3-G-BT
Wireless
Wired

Wired Wireless
Handy Terminal Wired

Torque Indicator
CD5

Software Bluetooth® Adapter Software

4
Selection of Torque
Products
Characteristic factors (4M's) of defects in bolt tightening
1. MAN (Tightening operator human error) 3. MACHINE (Improper tightening equipment)
· Missed tightening · Inaccuracy
· Improper tightening tool usage · Mechanical failure
2. METHOD (Improper tightening specification) 4. MATERIAL (Improper screw joint material)
· Wrong tightening value specification · Part out of tolerance
· Wrong tightening procedure · Defective part material
· Wrong tightening tool selection · Insufficient screw part lubricant

Data Management System


for Backup

System Manual Tightening Data


g System) Management System

tery-Less Wireless Battery Operated Marking Torque Marking Marking Torque Torque Wrench Data Transfer
Torque Wrenoh Torque Wrench Screwdriver Torque Wrench Wrench with Sensor with Sensor Torque Wrench

For Hexagon
QLBL HAC MNTD CSPD CSPFD CEM3-G-BTD
Head Bolt For Hexagon
MPQL Duplex
Wireless Wireless Head Bolt
MQSPFD

CSPFDD
For Hexagon
Socket Head Bolt Wireless
CMQSP Wired HACQSPDY
R-BL R-BT

Wireless Wireless
Wireless
MPQLFH Receiver
Torque Indicator R-FHD256
Wired CD5
Wired
R-BT
MPQLLS Bluetooth® Adapter

ntrol Software Wired


Visual Check

on Data Tool Management System


nt System for Manual Tools

Digital Type Periodical Daily


Torque Driver Calibration Inspection

Torque Driver Torque Wrench Torque Wrench


Tester Tester Checker

STC2-G
STC2-G-BT MEASUREMENT

esc
Serial Number
TOH000-A12345
Model Name
CEM100N3X15D
Ch
1
Accuracy (%)
3.0
13/8/9

Click Type
14:00

Zero
0.0000 N.m
Set Torque 1 2 3 4 5

Clear 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000 20.000

40.000 40.000 44.000 40.000 40.000 40.000

60.000 60.000 60.000 60.000 63.500 60.000


MEMORY 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000 80.000

100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00

Wired

Wireless
TDT3-G DOTE3-G TCC2-G TF LC3-G

Software

5
Rotary Slip Adjustable Assembly Adjustable Rotary Slip Graduation RoHS
RTD Torque Screwdriver
• Ratcheting mechanism prevents over torque.
• Torque easily set with external scale
Direction
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
[cN·m] Metric [kgf·cm] American [ozf·in/lbf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
ozf·in ozf·in
- - - - - - RTD20Z 6-20 0.2
100 50
- - - - - - RTD40Z 15-40 0.5
Torque Screwdriver

- - - - - - RTD80Z 20-80 1 110 80


RTD60CN
- - - - - - RTD150Z 30-150 2 130 160
lbf·in lbf·in
RTD15CN 2-15 0.1 1.5RTD 0.2-1.5 0.01 RTD1.3I 0.2-1.3 0.01
100 50
RTD30CN 4-30 0.2 3RTD 0.4-3 0.02 RTD2.6I 0.4-2.6 0.02
RTD60CN 10-60 0.5 6RTD 1-6 0.05 RTD5I 1-5 0.05 110 80
RTD120CN 20-120 1 12RTD 2-12 0.1 RTD10I 2-10 0.1 130 160
RTD120CN with Resin Grip RTD260CN 60-260 2 26RTD 6-26 0.2 RTD22I 6-22 0.2 150 270
RTD500CN 100-500 5 50RTD 10-50 0.5 RTD40I 10-40 0.5 155 320

Note 1. Auxiliary tightening tool for RTD500CN is sold separately.


2. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
Standard Accessories 1. Hook spanner for RTD260CN and RTD500CN
2. Resin grip for RTD120CN and RTD260CN

Adjustable Torque
LTD Screwdriver
Assembly Adjustable

• Clicks at set torque value


Graduation RoHS

Direction • Torque easily set with external scale


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
[cN·m] Metric [kgf·cm] American [ozf·in/lbf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
ozf·in ozf·in
- - - - - - LTD20Z 6-20 0.2
100 50
- - - - - - LTD40Z 15-40 0.5
LTD60CN - - - - - - LTD80Z 20-80 1 110 80
- - - - - - LTD150Z 30-150 2 130 160
lbf·in lbf·in
LTD15CN 2-15 0.1 1.5LTD 0.2-1.5 0.01 LTD1.3I 0.2-1.3 0.01
100 50
LTD30CN 4-30 0.2 3LTD 0.4-3 0.02 LTD2.6I 0.4-2.6 0.02
LTD60CN 10-60 0.5 6LTD 1-6 0.05 LTD5I 1-5 0.05 110 80
LTD120CN 20-120 1 12LTD 2-12 0.1 LTD10I 2-10 0.1 130 160
LTD260CN 60-260 2 26LTD 6-26 0.2 LTD22I 6-22 0.2 150 270
LTD120CN with Resin Grip LTD500CN 100-500 50LTD 10-50 LTD40I 10-40 155 320
LTD1000CN 200-1000 5 100LTD 20-100 0.5 LTD90I 20-90 0.5 185 580
LTD2000CN 300-2000 200LTD 30-200 LTD180I 30-180 255 1150

Note 1. Auxiliary tightening tool for LTD500CN and LTD1000CN is available, sold separately.
2. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
3. Bits for LTD2000CN are Tohnichi original.
Standard Accessories 1. Hook spanner for LTD260CN-LTD2000CN
2. LTD2000CN comes with an auxiliary tightening tool.
3. Resin grip for LTD120CN and LTD260CN

Torque Screwdriver Optional Accessories ADJUSTING TOOL for RTD/LTD HOOK SPANNER
RESIN GRIP for 120CN, 260CN • Used for zero adjustment for RTD/LTD/MNTD
GRAY GREEN BLUE • Torque setting for middle and large
size torque screwdriver

Part # Applicable Model


ORANGE
RED
51 LTD/RTD15CN, 30CN
BLACK
46 LTD/RTD60CN Part # Applicable Model
For 120CN For 260CN 47 LTD/RTD260CN 52 LTD/RTD260CN, MNTD120CN
Part # Color Applicable Model Part # Color Applicable Model 48 LTD/RTD500CN 53 LTD/RTD500CN, MNTD260CN
850 Orange 856 Orange RTD260CN 49 LTD/RTD1000CN 54 LTD1000CN, MNTD500CN
851 Gray 857 Gray LTD260CN 1046 LTD/RTD120CN 55 LTD2000CN
RTD120CN
852 Black LTD120CN 858 Black
853 Green RNTD120CN 859 Green
NTD120CN
RNTD260CN AUXILIARY TIGHTENING TOOL TORQUE ADJUSTING BAR
854 Red 860 Red NTD260CN
855 Blue 861 Blue for RTD/LTD/RNTD/NTD for RNTD/NTD/RNTDZ
• Make easier for large torque tightening • Used for torque setting of preset
Resin Grip Dimensions torque screwdriver
120CN 260CN
RTD RNTD RTD RNTD
LTD NTD LTD NTD
Hexagon width across flats
33 41 Part # Applicable Model Part # Applicable Model
Maximum value [mm]
Hexagon width across corner 31 LTD/RTD/NTD/RNTD500CN 42 NTD/RNTD15CN-120CN
Maximum value [mm] 35 44
32 LTD/NTD1000CN, RTDFH/RNTDFH500CN 43 NTD/RNTD260CN, RNTDZ260CN
Length [mm] 67 81 68 40 LTD2000CN 44 NTD/RNTD500CN-1000CN, RNTDZ500CN
RTDLS500CN
Overall Length with torque 1031
screwdriver [mm] 130 110 150 110 RNTDSL500CN

6
Rotary Slip Preset
RNTD Torque Screwdriver
Assembly

• Preset version of RTD


Preset Rotary Slip RoHS

Direction • No external scale, torque set by a torque driver tester Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [g]
RNTD15CN 5-15 0.5-1.5 0.5-1.3
RNTD30CN 10-30 1-3 1-2.5 95 71
RNTD60CN 20-60 2-6 2-5
RNTD120CN 40-120 4-12 4-10 110

Torque Screwdriver
RNTD60CN 110
RNTD260CN 100-260 10-26 10-22 180
RNTD500CN 200-500 20-50 20-40 120 270

Note 1. A torque driver tester is necessary for torque setting.


Specify required set torque when you order. Ex. RNTD120CN × 100cN·m
2. Torque adjusting bar is sold separately. Refer to page 46.
3. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
Standard Accessories 1. Resin grip for RNTD120CN and RNTD260CN
RNTD120CN with Resin Grip 2. Auxiliary tightening bar for RNTD500CN

Preset Torque
NTD Screwdriver
Assembly

• Preset version of LTD


Preset RoHS

Direction • No external scale, torque set by a torque driver tester Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [g]
NTD15CN 5-15 0.5-15 0.5-1.3
NTD30CN 10-30 1-3 1-2.5 95 70
NTD60CN 20-60 2-6 2-5
NTD60CN NTD120CN 40-120 4-12 4-10 110
110
NTD260CN 100-260 10-26 10-22 180
NTD500CN 200-500 20-50 20-40 120 270
NTD1000CN 400-1000 40-100 40-90 155 550

Note 1. A torque driver tester is necessary for torque setting.


Specify required set torque when you order. Ex. NTD120CN × 100cN·m
2. Torque adjusting bar is sold separately. Refer to page 46.
NTD120CN with Resin Grip Standard Accessories 1. Resin grip for NTD120CN and NTD260CN
2. Auxiliary tightening bar for NTD500CN and NTD1000CN

NTD500CN with Auxiliary Tightening Bar

RoHS
RTDZ Assembly Adjustable Rotary Slip Resin Body

• Insulated design suited for use in electric shock hazard conditions


Direction Insulated Rotary Slip • Ideal for electric car assembly, connection of battery terminal wiring work etc
Adjustable Torque Accuracy ±3%

Screwdriver Torque Range


Metric
Torque Range Torque Range Overall
Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
RTDZ260CN 60-260 2 26RTDZ 6-26 0.2 - - 150 220
RTDZ500CN 100-500 5 50RTDZ 10-50 0.5 - - 183 380

Note 1. Torque adjusting bar is sold separately. Refer to page 6.


2. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
3. Bits are not insulation coating.
RTDZ260CN

RoHS
RNTDZ Assembly Preset Rotary Slip Resin Body

• Insulated design suited for use in electric shock hazard conditions


Direction Insulated Rotary Slip Preset • Ideal for electric car assembly, connection of battery terminal wiring work etc
Torque Screwdriver Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
[cN·m] Metric [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Length
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
RNTDZ260CN 100-260 - - 10-26 - 10-22 - 123 240
RNTDZ500CN 200-500 - - 20-50 - 20-40 - 138 340

Note 1. A torque driver tester is necessary for torque setting.


Specify required torque when you order. Ex. RNTDZ260CN × 200cN·m
RNTDZ500CN 2. Torque adjusting bar is sold separately. Refer to page 6.
3. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
4. Bits are not insulation coating.

7
AMRD/BMRD Assembly

• Low torque version of RTD


Adjustable Rotary Slip Graduation RoHS

Direction Rotary Slip Adjustable • AMRD includes Tohnichi original bits.


Torque Screwdriver for Accuracy ±3%

Small Screws Torque Range


Metric
Torque Range
American
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Standard Accessory
S.I. Model [cN·m] [gf·cm/kgf·cm] [ozf·in/lbf·in] Length Bit
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g] + - Thickness × Width
AMRD cN·m cN·m gf·cm gf·cm ozf·in ozf·in
AMRD1CN 0.3-1 0.01 100AMRD 30-100 1 - - -
0.15 × 1
AMRD2CN 0.5-2 0.025 200AMRD 50-200 2.5 AMRD3Z 1-3 0.05
AMRD4CN 93 26 #0 0.2 × 1.5
Torque Screwdriver

AMRD4CN 1-4 0.05 400AMRD 100-400 5 AMRD6Z 2-6 0.1


0.3 × 2
AMRD8CN 2-8 800AMRD 200-800 10 AMRD12Z 3-12 0.2
BMRD 0.1 kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
BMRD15CN2 2-15 1.5BMRD2 0.2-1.5 0.01 1.5BMRD2-A 0.2-1.5 0.005
116 50 - -
BMRD30CN2 4-30 0.2 3BMRD2 0.4-3 0.02 3BMRD2-A 0.4-3 0.01
BMRD30CN2 Note 1. Bits for BMRD are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
2. Bits for AMRD are supplied from only Tohnichi.

AMLD/BMLD Assembly

• Low torque version of LTD


Adjustable Graduation RoHS

Direction Adjustable Torque • AMLD includes Tohnichi original bits.


Screwdriver for Small Accuracy ±3%
Screws Torque Range
Metric
Torque Range
American
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Standard Accessory
S.I. Model [cN·m] [gf·cm/kgf·cm] [ozf·in/lbf·in] Length Bit
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g] + - Thickness × Width
AMLD cN·m cN·m gf·cm gf·cm ozf·in ozf·in
AMLD1CN 0.3-1 0.01 100AMLD 30-100 1 - - -
0.15 × 1
AMLD4CN AMLD2CN 0.5-2 0.025 200AMLD 50-200 2.5 AMLD3Z 1-3 0.05
83 26 #0 0.2 × 1.5
AMLD4CN 1-4 0.05 400AMLD 100-400 5 AMLD6Z 2-6 0.1
0.3 × 2
AMLD8CN 2-8 800AMLD 200-800 10 AMLD12Z 3-12 0.2
BMLD 0.1 kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
BMLD15CN2 2-15 1.5BMLD2 0.2-1.5 0.01 1.5BMLD2-A 0.2-1.5 0.005
116 50 - -
BMLD30CN2 BMLD30CN2 4-30 0.2 3BMLD2 0.4-3 0.02 3BMLD2-A 0.4-3 0.01

Note 1. Bits for BMLD are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
2. Bits for AMLD are supplied from only Tohnichi.

Daily Check and Calibration of Torque Screwdrivers


Digital Torque Gauges for Daily Inspections

One use of ATGE-G and BTGE-G digital torque gauges is


to check the accuracy of small torque screwdrivers such as
AMLD/AMRD and BMLD/BMRD. Monitoring drivers with daily
inspections confirms driver function and accuracy prior to use.
Refer to page 57 and 58.
• ATGE-G
• BTGE-G
• ATGE-G with Measurement stand, #808
• BTGE-G with Measurement stand, #809
Torque checking figure for AMRD Torque checking figure for BMRD
with ATGE-G and measurement with BTGE-G
stand, #808.

Torque Driver Tester for Calibration and Adjustments

TDT3-G digital torque screwdriver testers are for the calibration


of torque screwdrivers such as click type and indicating type.
The loading device keeps the driver steady and in a vertical
position during testing for highly accurate calibration and easy
adjustments.
• TDT3-G: Refer to page 53.

Click type RTD with TDT3-G Indicating type FTD with TDT3-G

8
Marking Torque Assembly Preset RoHS
MNTD Screwdriver
• Non-rotary prest type marking torque screwdriver
• Total 7 types of phillips and hexagon bits available
NEW • Marking screws as torque is achieved
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range
Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Overall Length Weight
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [g]
MNTD120CN NEW MNTD120CN 40-120 4-12 4-10 150 210
NEW MNTD260CN 100-260 10-26 10-22 152 315
NEW MNTD500CN 200-500 20-50 20-40 168 365

Torque Screwdriver
Note 1. MNTD special desiged bits and markers are sold separately.
2. Tester is requrired to set/change a torque value.
3. MNTD is not applicable with hexagon socket set screws.
4. Dark colored screws might not be suitable to detect MNTD marking.
MNTD500CN
Standard Accessories Green resin grip for 120CN and 260CN. Auxialiary tightening tool for 500CN

MNTD Optional Accessories


MNTD Plus Bit MNTD Marker
Red marked screw Part # Model Applicable Screw/Ref. Part # Model
1601 MNTD #1 bit M2.5, (M3) 1621 MNTD Marker Red 10 pcs/set
Auxialiary Tightening Tool 1602 MNTD #2 bit M3, M4, M5 1622 MNTD Marker Red 100 pcs/set
for MNTD500CN 1603 MNTD #3 bit M6 1623 MNTD Marker Blue 10 pcs/set
1624 MNTD Marker Blue 100 pcs/set
MNTD Hex Bit Note 1. It is a disposable marker.
Blue marked screw Part # Model Applicable Screw/Ref. 2. 1 pc of marker are capable of 1000
1611 MNTD W2.5 bit M3 marking operations.
1612 MNTD W3 bit M4
1613 MNTD W4 bit M5 Preset Hook Spanner for MNTD
1614 MNTD W5 bit M6 Part # Applicable Model
1. Tohnichi special designed bit is 52 MNTD120CN
1601 1611 Note
required for MNTD. 53 MNTD260CN
MNTD Bit 2. Applicable for screw that head 54 MNTD500CN
diameter is over ø 5.5mm. Note To set/change torque value.
Unavailable to hexagon set screws.
Blue MNTD Marker 3. In M3 screw, only binding head
screw is applicable.

RTDLS/RNTDLS Assembly RoHS


• RTD/RNTD style with Limit Switch output
Direction Rotary Slip Type Torque • Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
Screwdriver with Limit Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
Switch S.I. Model [cN·m]
Metric
[kgf·cm]
American
[lbf·in] Length
Weight
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
RTDLS120CN 20-120 1 12RTDLS 2-12 0.1 RTDLS10I 2-10 0.1 184 340
RTDLS260CN 60-260 2 26RTDLS 6-26 0.2 RTDLS22I 6-22 0.2 201 450
RTDLS500CN 100-500 5 50RTDLS 10-50 0.5 RTDLS40I 10-40 0.5 212 540
RNTDLS120CN 40-120 4-12 4-10 166 320
RNTDLS260CN 100-260 - - 10-26 - - 10-22 - 167 390
RNTDLS500CN 200-500 20-50 20-40 175 480
Note 1. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.
RTDLS120CN 2. RNTDLS models are required a torque driver tester for torque setting.
Specify required torque when you order. Ex. RNTDLS120CN × 100cN·m
3. Limit switch specifications AC30V below 1A, DC30V below 1A
4. Female connector for LS cable is sold separately. Part# WA5219K.

POKA Patrol, Count Checker


CNA-4mk3
Refer to page 28.
RNTDLS120CN

* Sold separately

RTDFH/RNTDFH Assembly RoHS


• Torque screwdriver with wireless error-proofing, Pokayoke, function
Rotary Slip Type Pokayoke • High reliable FHSS technology with universal 2.4GHz frequency band
NEW Torque Screwdriver Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g]
NEW RTDFH120CN 20-120 1 12RTDFH 2-12 0.1 RTDFH10I 2-10 0.1 184 280
NEW RTDFH260CN 60-260 2 26RTDFH 6-26 0.2 RTDFH22I 6-22 0.2 201 380
NEW RTDFH500CN 100-500 5 50RTDFH 10-50 0.5 RTD40I 10-40 0.5 212 490
RTDFH120CN RNTDFH120CN NEW RNTDFH120CN 40-120 4-12 4-10 166 260
NEW RNTDFH260CN 100-260 - - 10-26 - - 10-22 - 167 320
Transmitter Specifications on Torque screwdriver NEW RNTDFH500CN 200-500 20-50 20-40 175 430

Model RTDFH256/RNTDFH256 Note 1. RTDFH/RNTDFH are ESD/Electro Static discharge.


2. Refer to page 30 for receiver and setting box.
2.4GHz band (2.402GHz~2.479GHz, 1MHz
Frequency Band 3. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.
interval 78ch) 4. Auxiliary tightening tool for RTDFH/RNTDFH500CN is part # 32.
Communication System Spread spectrum (frequency hopping system)
Standard Accessories Adjusting handle : RTDFH500CN and RNTDFH500CN
Modulation System GFSK
Modulation Rate 1Mbps
Group Channel Gr 000~255 Receiver POKA Patrol, Count Checker
ID 3 digit (000~999), 7 digit (alphanumeric)
Input/Output
Power[V]
-
DV3V(CR2032) R-FH256 CNA-4mk3
Antenna Chip Antenna
Display LED Refer to page 28 and 30 for Refer to page 28.
Operating Temperature [°C] 0~45 Pokayoke system configuration.
Transmitting Receiving Distance approx. 5~10m
*Sold separately * Sold separately

9
Dial Indicating Torque Inspection Dial Indicating Memory Pointer Direct Reading RoHS
FTD Screwdriver with
Memory Pointer
• Ideal for measuring torque
• FTD-S with memory pointer; FTD with preset knob
Direction Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Standard Accessory
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m] [gf·cm/kgf·cm] [ozf·in/lbf·in] Length Bit
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g] + - Thickness × Width
FTD-S cN·m cN·m gf·cm gf·cm ozf·in ozf·in
FTD2CN-S 0.3-2 0.05 02FTD2-S 30-200 5 FTD3Z2-S 0.5-3 0.1
FTD5CN-S 0.5-5 0.1 05FTD2-S 50-500 10 FTD7Z2-S 1-7 0.2
FTD200CN2-S
Torque Screwdriver

kgf·cm kgf·cm 152 140


FTD10CN-S 1-10 0.2 1FTD2-S 0.1-1 0.02 FTD15Z2-S 2-15 0.5
Interchangeable bit is
FTD20CN-S 3-20 0.5 2FTD2-S 0.3-2 0.05 FTD30Z2-S 5-30 1
sold separately.
FTD50CN2-S 5-50 1 5FTD2-S 0.5-5 0.1 FTD70Z2-S 10-70 2
Refer to page 11.
lbf·in lbf·in
- - - - - - 5FTD2-A-S 0.5-5 0.1
272 370
FTD100CN2-S 10-100 2 10FTD2-S 1-10 0.2 10FTD2-A-S 1-10 0.2
FTD200CN2-S 30-200 5 20FTD2-S 3-20 0.5 20FTD2-A-S 3-20 0.5
FTD400CN2-S 50-400 10 40FTD2-S 5-40 1 40FTD2-A-S 5-40 1
FTD100CN N·m N·m
FTD8N2-S 1-8 0.2 80FTD2-S 10-80 2 80FTD2-A-S 10-70 2 900
338 #3 1.2 × 8
FTD16N2-S 3-16 0.5 160FTD2-S 30-160 5 160FTD2-A-S 20-140 5 930
FTD cN·m cN·m
FTD50CN 10-50 1 5FTD 1-5 0.1 5FTD-A 1-5 0.1 285 #1
215 0.7 × 7
FTD100CN 20-100 2 10FTD 2-10 0.2 10FTD-A 1-10 0.2 290
FTD200CN 40-200 5 20FTD 4-20 0.5 20FTD-A 3-20 0.5 390 #2
263 0.9 × 7
FTD400CN 80-400 10 40FTD 8-40 1.0 40FTD-A 5-40 1 410

Note FTD8N2-S, FTD16N2-S: Square drive type, 6.35mm


Standard Accessories Auxiliary tightening bar for FTD8N2-S and FTD16N2-S

Micro Dial Indicating


MTD Torque Screwdriver
Inspection Dial Indicating

• Low torque capacity version of FTD


Direct Reading RoHS

Direction • Requires special size bits


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Standard Accessory
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [mN·m] [gf·cm] [ozf·in] Length Bit
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [g] + - Thickness × Width
MTD1MN 0.1-1 0.02 10MTD 1-10 0.2 - - - 110 22
0.15 × 1
MTD2MN 0.3-2 0.05 20MTD 3-20 0.5 - - -
100 21 #0 0.2 × 15
MTD5MN 0.5-5 0.1 50MTD 5-50 1 MTD07Z 0.1-0.7
0.02 0.3 × 2
MTD10MN 1-10 0.2 100MTD 10-100 2 MTD1.4Z 0.2-1.4 132 23
MTD5MN
Note MTD models require Tohnichi made bits. Refer to page 11.

Digital Torque
STC2-G/-BT Screwdriver
Assembly Inspection

• Ideal for tightening and inspection operation


Digital Bit Direct Reading

RoHS
Rechargeable

Direction • 1000 data memory storage and data output function


• Color LED indicator, White, Blue, Yellow, and Red Accuracy ±1%
Torque Range Overall
Model Weight
[cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] [ozf·in] Length
®
Standard Version Bluetooth Version Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit [mm] [g]
STC50CN2-G STC50CN2-G-BT 10-50 0.05 1-5 0.005 1-4.4 0.005 15-70 0.05
STC200CN2-G STC200CN2-G-BT 40-200 0.2 4-20 0.02 4-17 0.02 - - 230 325
STC400CN2-G STC400CN2-G-BT 80-400 0.5 8-40 0.05 8-35 0.05 - -

Note 1. Bits are sold separately. Refer to page 11.


2. Bits size as below
3. Display can be turned upside down with keypad operation.
4. Data output of standard version is through USB only.
5. Data output of Bluetooth® version is through USB and Bluetooth®.
6. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.
Standard Accessories USB cable/384, AC adapter/BA-7, and Battery pack/BP-7. Refer to page 47.

White LED light Blue LED light Yellow & Red flashing LED light
STC200CN2-G 80% of target torque Achieving target torque Over torque indication

STC2-G/-BT Specifications STC2-G-BT Communication Specifications


Accuracy ±1% Bluetooth® Version V3.0 [EX.] Torque checking figure
Measurement Mode Tightening / Inspection mode Transmitting System AFH for torque screwdriver
Battery Indicator 4 levels Moduration System GFSK
Judgment Mode Buzzar and LED indicator on upper/lower limit Wireless Output 4dBm
Basic Functions Auto-power off, Auto memory & reset, Auto zero setting Transmission Power Class Class 2
Power Supply Lithium Ion Battery Profile SPP
Data Output USB Communication Distance approx. 10m
Operating Time approx. 30 hours Operating Time 15 hours
AC adaptor: approx. 5 hours STC2-G
Recharging Time
USB through PC: approx.10 hours

10
Interchangeable Bit
From Torque Tool
RoHS RTD/RTDZ/LTD
BMRD
FTD8N2-S - AMRD
+ Plus Bit
⃝ Torque Screwdriver -
BMLD
FTD16N2-S, AMLD LTD2000CN -
FTD50CN - 400CN
(FTD8N - 16N) MTD
− Minus Bit
⃝ FTD2CN-S - 400CN2-S
STC2-G
Power Torque Tool U30CN U (except U30CN) - - - AUR5N
Box Bit
Root Shape Sign A B C D F G H
Hex Bit

Square Bit

Torque Screwdriver
Root Shape and Dimensions
Hexalobular Bit

Tohnichi Original Common Tohnichi Original Tohnichi Original Tohnichi Original Common
Sign Size Screw
Bit (Standard) Bit Bit Bit (Standard)
Plus 0 #0 (S-0) Refer to Table A 104 109 115
1 #1 (H-1) Refer to Table A 85 106 84 116

⃝ 2 #2 (H-2) Refer to Table A 86 107 80
3 #3 (H-3) Refer to Table A 87 81 35 700
4 #4 (H-4) Refer to Table A 36
Minus 10 0.15 × 1 Refer to Table B 111
11 0.2 × 1.5 Refer to Table B 112

⃝ 12 0.3 × 2 Refer to Table B 113
13 0.4 × 2.4 Refer to Table B 105
14 0.6 × 3.8 Refer to Table B 108
15 0.7 × 7 Refer to Table B 88
16 0.9 × 7 Refer to Table B 89
17 1 × 10 Refer to Table B 37
18 1 × 12 Refer to Table B 38
19 1.2 × 17 Refer to Table B 39
20 1.6 × 10 Refer to Table B 82
21 1.2 × 8 Refer to Table B 83
Box Hex Bolt
W 5.5 5.5 M3 91
W6 6 (M3.5) 95
From Bolt

W7 7 M4 92
W8 8 (M4.5) M5 93
W 10 10 M6 94
Hex Cap Screw Set Screw
W 1.27 1.27 M2.5 56
W 1.5 1.5 M3 57
W2 2 M2.5 M4 58
W 2.5 2.5 M3 M5 59
W3 3 M4 M6 60
W4 4 M5 M8 61
W5 5 M6 M10 62
W6 6 M8 M12 (M14) 63
W8 8 M10 M16 (M18) 64
Square 2 6.35 (1/4) 90 33
Drive 3 9.53 (3/8) 34
Hexalobular Flat Head Socket Head Set Screw
T5 M2 M2.5 470
T6 M2 M3 471
T7 M3.5
T8 M2.5 M2.5 M4 472

d
B(Width across flats)
Bolt Head Shape (Ref.)
Nominal Size of Hex head Bolt Small Hex Head High Strength Hex Bolt Hex Socket Head Hex Socket Set How to order:
Screw (d) (B) Bolt (B) for Friction Grip Joint (B) Cap Screw (B) Screw (B) Indicate the model name and catalog No.
M2.5 4.5 - - 2 1.27 Hex Bolt
d (EXAMPLE) MODEL NAME CATALOG No.
M3 5.5 - - 2.5 1.5
(M3.5) 6 - - - - + BIT A - 0
○ 104
M4 7 - - 3 2 B (Width across flats)

(M4.5) 8 - - - -
 Root Shape Sign Point Shape Sign
M5 8 - - 4 2.5 Cap Screw
M6 10 - - 5 3 d
(M7) 11 - - - -
M8 13 12 - 6 4 d
B (Width across flats ) + Size of Bits
⃝ Table A
M10 16 17 14 - 8 5
M12 18 19 17 22 10 No. of Cross Nominal
(M14) 21 22 19 - 12
6 Set Screw Size of Screw (d)
Hole No. Remark
d
M16 24 22 27 M1.6, M2 #0 (S-0)
14 8
(M18) 27 24 - [M2], (M2.2), M2.5, (M3) #1 (H-1) Pan head screw, Flat head screw,
Pan flat screw, Bind screw
M20 30 27 32 10 B (Width across flats) M3, (M3.5), M4, (M4.5), M5 #2 (H-2)
17 [(M3) #1 is bind small screw only]
(M22) 32 34 30 36 - M6 #3 (H-3) [(M2) #1 is not compliant with ISO]
M24 36 32 41 - M8, M10 #4 (H-4)
19
(M27) 41 36 46 -
M30 46 41 50 22 -
a

(M33) 50 46 - 24 -
Flat Head Screw
b

M36 55 50 - - Table B
27
(M39) 60 55 - - Nominal Size (b) M1 M1.2 (M1.4) M1.6 (M1.7) M2 (M2.2M) M2.3 M2.5 (M2.6) M3 (M3.5) M4 (M4.5) M5 M6 M8 M10
M42 65 - - 32 - Groove ISO Screws 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.2 1.6 2 2.5
JIS JIS B 1180 JIS B 1180 JIS B 1186 JIS B 1176 JIS B 1177 Width (a) Non-ISO Screws 0.32 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.6

11
Ratchet Head Assembly Adjustable Ratchet Head Graduation RoHS
QL/QLE2 Type Adjustable
Torque Wrench
• Basic adjustable click style with resin grip
• Torque value easily set with external scale and knob
Direction

QL5N

QLE750N2 QL100N4
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
Metric American Weight
QL/QL-MH Optional Accessories S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [Ibf·in/lbf·ft]Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
QL N·m N ·m kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
QL2N 0.4-2 0.02 20QL 4-20 0.2 QL15I-2A 3-15 0.1
194 0.27
QL5N 1-5 0.05 50QL 10-50 0.5 QL30I-2A 6-30 0.2
QL10N 2-10 100QL 20-100 QL50I-2A 10-50 6.35
0.1 1 0.5 219 0.29
QL15N 3-15 150QL 30-150 QL100I-2A 20-100
QL25N5-1/4 225QL5-1/4 QL200I-2A
Torque Wrench for

5-25 0.2 50-250 2.5 50-200 2.5 237 0.33


842 846 QL25N5 225QL5 QL200I-3A
QL50N 10-50 0.5 450QL3 100-500 5 QL400I-3A 100-400 5 260 0.45
Assembly

- - - - - - QL750I-3A 150-750 10 9.53


Carrying Case (P.46) lbf·ft lbf·ft
335 0.69
Applicable Model QL100N4-3/8 20-100 900QL4-3/8 200-1000 QL75F-3A 15-75 1
Part #
Dimension [mm] QL100N4 20-100 1 900QL4 200-1000 10 - - -
QL50N, QL50N-MH, QL100N4-MH QL140N 30-140 1400QL3 300-1400 QL100F-4A 30-100 1 400 0.88
842
H60 × W400 × D70 QL200N4 40-200 1800QL4 400-2000 20 QL150F-4A 30-150 490 12.7 1.4
QL140N, QL140N-MH, QL200N4, QL200N4-MH kgf·m kgf·m
843 QL280N-1/2 2 2800QL3-1/2 QL200F-4A 30-210 2
H60 × W520 × D80 40-280 4-28 695 2.0
QL140N, QL140N-MH and below QL280N 2800QL3 - -
846 0.2
H170 × W500 × D100 QL420N 60-420 4200QL2 6-42 QL300F-6A 60-300 995 3.4
QL280N, QL280N-MH and below QLE2 N·m N·m kgf·m kgf·m lbf·ft lbf·ft 19.05
847 QLE550N2 100-550 5500QLE2 10-55 QLE400F-6A 100-400 1189 4.3
H170 × W740 × D100
QLE750N2 150-750 5 7500QLE2 15-75 0.5 QLE600F-6A 150-600 5 1342 5.6
QLE1000N2 200-1000 10000QLE2 20-100 QLE700F-8A 200-700 1515 7.7
QLE1400N2 300-1400 14000QLE2 30-140 QLE1000F-8A 300-1000 1787 25.4 11.1
10 1 10
QLE2100N2 500-2100 21000QLE2 50-210 QLE1500F-8A 500-1500 1895 14.6
QLE2800N2 800-2800 20 28000QLE2 80-280 2 QLE2000F-12A 600-2000 20 2405 38.1 23.7
880
Note 1. QL2N-QL25N5 are yellow/black resin grips. QL50N-QL280N are black resin grips.
2. QL420N and QLE550N2-QLE2800N2 are knurled handles.
3. Use a through-hole socket for square drive over 25.4mm.
4. QLE2 models with built-in Adjusting Handle

879 881

Color Cap
Part # Color Applicable Model
QLLS RoHS

879 Red QL2N, QL5N


• QL style with Limit Switch output
880 Blue QL10N, QL15N, • Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system QLLS100N4
881 Green QL25N5-1/4,
882 Black QL25N5 for assembly processes
S.I. Model Metric Model
POKA Patrol, Count Checker
QLMS2N-MH 20QLMS-MH
QLMS5N-MH
QLMS10N-MH
50QLMS-MH
100QLMS-MH
CNA-4mk3
QLMS10N 100QLMS Refer to page 28.
QLMS15N 150QLMS
QLMS15N-MH 150QLMS-MH
QLLS25N5 225QL5LS
QLLS50N 450QL3LS
Protective Head Cover QLLS100N4 900QL4LS * Sold separately
Refer to page 46. QLLS140N 1400QL3LS
QLLS200N4 1800QL4LS
QLLS280N 2800QL3LS
QLLS420N 4200QL2LS

QL-MH Ratchet Head Type


Adjustable Torque
Assembly Adjustable

• Knurled metal handle version of QL


Ratchet Head Graduation RoHS

Direction Wrench with Metal


• Ideal for oily working conditions
Handle Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Overall Square
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [Ibf·in]
Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
QL2N-MH 0.4-2.0 0.02 20QL-MH 4-20 0.2 QL15I-2A-MH 3-15 0.1
160 0.16
QL100N4-MH QL5N-MH 1-5 0.05 50QL-MH 10-50 0.5 QL30I-2A-MH 6-30 0.2
6.35
QL10N-MH 2-10 100QL-MH 20-100 QL50I-2A-MH 10-50 0.5
0.1 1 195 0.19
QL15N-MH 3-15 150QL-MH 30-150 QL100I-2A-MH 20-100 1
QL25N-MH 5-25 0.25 225QL-MH 50-250 2.5 - - - 230 0.25
9.53
QL50N-MH 10-50 0.5 450QL-MH 100-500 5 - - - 260 0.45
QL100N4-MH 20-100 900QL4-MH 200-1000 - - - 335 0.69
1 10
QL5N-MH QL140N-MH 30-140 1400QL-MH 300-1400 - - - 400 12.7 0.88
QL200N4-MH 40-200 1800QL4-MH 400-2000 20 - - - 490 1.4
2 kgf·m kgf·m
QL280N-MH 40-280 2800QL-MH 4-28 0.2 - - - 695 19.05 1.9

12
Interchangeable Assembly Adjustable Interchangeable Graduation RoHS
CL/CLE2 Head Type
Adjustable
• Interchangeable Head can be easily exchanged.
• Torque value easily set with external scale and knob
Direction Torque Wrench

CL2N×8D
Interchangeable Head

CLE850N2×32D CL100N×15D
Accuracy ±3%
SH AH2 RH Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Tohnichi Overall
Metric American Weight
Head S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
CL N·m N·m kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
CL2N×8D 0.4-2 0.02 20CL 4-20 0.2 CL15I×8D 3-15 0.1
QH RQH DH 174 0.24
CL5N×8D 1-5 0.05 50CL 10-50 0.5 CL30I×8D 6-30 0.2
8D
CL10N×8D 2-10 100CL 20-100 CL50I×8D 10-50
0.1 1 0.5 199 0.26

Torque Wrench for


CL15N×8D 3-15 150CL 30-150 CL100I×8D 20-100
10D CL25N5×10D 5-25 0.2 225CL5 50-250 2.5 CL200I×10D 50-200 2.5 216 0.3
12D CL50N×12D 450CL3 450CL3-A 100-400 230

Assembly
HH SH-N FH 10-50 0.5 100-500 5 5 0.37
CL50N×15D 500CL3 500CL3-A 100-450 235
CL100N×15D 20-100 900CL3 200-1000 900CL3-A 200-800 10 310 0.52
15D
1 10 lbf·ft lbf·ft
CL140N×15D 30-140 1400CL3 300-1400 1400CL3-A 30-100 1 370 0.67
19D CL200N×19D 40-200 1800CL3 400-2000 20 1800CL3-A 30-150 455 1.2
CL/CL-MH Optional Accessories kgf·m kgf·m
2 2
CL280N×22D 40-280 2800CL3 4-28 2800CL3-A 30-200 655 1.8
22D 0.2
CL420N×22D 60-420 4200CL2 6-42 4200CL2-A 60-300 940 3.1
CLE2 N·m N·m kgf·m kgf·m lbf·ft lbf·ft
CLE550N2×27D 100-550 5500CLE2 10-55 CLE400F×27D 100-400 1148 3.9
27D
CLE750N2×27D 150-750 7500CLE2 15-75 CLE550F×27D 150-550 1291 4.9
5 0.5 5
CLE850N2×32D 200-850 8500CLE2 20-85 CLE600F×32D 150-600 1297 5.1
32D
CLE1200N2×32D 300-1200 12000CLE2 30-120 CLE900F×32D 200-900 1464 6.9
842 846
Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head. Interchangeable heads are optional.
2. PH type interchangeable head/p.45 is not applicable.
Carrying Case (P.46) 3. CL2N - CL25N5 are yellow/black resin grips. CL50N - CL280N are black resin grips.
Applicable Model 4. CL420N and CLE550N2-CLE1200N2 are knurled handles.
Part # 5. CLE2 models with built-in Adjusting Handle
Dimension [mm]
CL50N×12D/15D, CL50N×12D/15D-MH,
842
CL100N×15D-MH H60 × W400 × D70

843
CL140N×15D/-MH, CL200N×19D/-MH
H60 × W520 × D80
CL200N×19D, CL200N×19D and below
CLLS RoHS

846
H170 × W500 × D100 • CL style with Limit Switch output
847
CL280N×22D, CL280N×22D-MH and below • Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
H170 × W740 × D100
S.I. Model Metric Model
CLMS2N×8D-MH 20CLMS-MH POKA Patrol, Count Checker
CLMS5N×8D-MH 50CLMS-MH
CLMS10N×8D-MH
CLMS10N×8D
100CLMS-MH
100CLMS
CNA-4mk3
CLMS15N×8D 150CLMS Refer to page 28.
879 880 881
CLMS15N×8D-MH 150CLMS-MH
CLLS25N5×10D 225CL5LS
Color Cap CLLS50N×12D 450CL3LS
Part # Color Applicable Model CLLS100N×15D 900CL3LS
879 Red CLLS140N×15D 1400CL3LS * Sold separately
880 Blue CL2N×8D, CL5N×8D
CL10N×8D, CL15N×8D CLLS200N×19D 1800CL3LS
881 Green CL25N5×10D CLLS280N×22D 2800CL3LS
882 Black CLLS420N×22D 4200CL2LS

Interchangeable
CL-MH Head Type
Assembly Adjustable

• Knurled metal handle version of CL


Interchangeable Graduation RoHS

Direction Adjustable Torque


• Ideal for oily working conditions
Wrench with Metal Accuracy ±3%
Handle Tohnichi Torque Range
Metric
Torque Range
American
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Head S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in] Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
CL2N×8D-MH 0.4-2 0.02 20CL-MH 4-20 0.2 CL15I×8D-MH 3-15 0.1
CL100N×15D-MH 140 0.13
CL5N×8D-MH 1-5 0.05 50CL-MH 10-50 0.5 CL30I×8D-MH 6-30 0.2
8D
CL10N×8D-MH 2-10 100CL-MH 20-100 CL50I×8D-MH 10-50 0.5
0.1 1 175 0.16
CL15N×8D-MH 3-15 150CL-MH 30-150 CL100I×8D-MH 20-100 1
10D CL25N×10D-MH 5-25 0.25 225CL-MH 50-250 2.5 - - - 200 0.22
12D CL50N×12D-MH 450CL-MH - - - 230
10-50 0.5 100-500 5 0.37
CL50N×15D-MH 500CL-MH - - - 235
15D CL100N×15D-MH 20-100 900CL-MH 200-1000 - - - 310 0.52
CL5N×8D-MH 1 10
CL140N×15D-MH 30-140 1400CL-MH 300-1400 - - - 370 0.67
19D CL200N×19D-MH 40-200 1800CL-MH 400-2000 20 - - - 455 1.2
2 kgf·m kgf·m
22D CL280N×22D-MH 40-280 2800CL-MH 4-28 0.2 - - - 655 1.6

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. PH type interchangeable head/p.45 is not applicable.
3. Interchangeable heads are optional.

13
DQL/DQLE2 Assembly Adjustable

• For bi-directional tightening


Ratchet Head Graduation Bi-Directional RoHS

Direction Dual Square Drives


• Ideal for tightening large vehicle tires
Type Adjustable Torque
Wrench

DQL200N4

DQL200N4 Optional Accessories


Carrying Case (P.46) DQLE750N2
Applicable Model Weight Accuracy ±3%
Part #
Dimension [mm] [kg]
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
DQL200N4 [N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·ft] Weight
843 0.36 S.I. Model Length Drive
Model Model
H60 × W520 × D80 Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
DQL280N and below DQL N·m N·m kgf·cm kgf·cm
847 1.0
H170 × W740 × D100 DQL200N4 40-200 1800DQL4 400-2000 20 1800DQL4-A 30-150 490 12.7 1.4
2 kgf·m kgf·m 2
Protective Head Cover DQL280N 40-280 2800DQL3 4-28 0.2 2800DQL3-A 30-210 695 2.0
Torque Wrench for

DQLE2 N·m N·m kgf·m kgf·m lbf·ft lbf·ft 19.0


DQLE550N2 100-550 5500DQLE2 10-55 DQLE400F-6A 100-400 1189 4.4
DQLE750N2 150-750 5 7500DQLE2 10-75 0.5 DQLE600F-6A 150-600 5 1342 5.7
Assembly

DQLE1000N2 200-1000 10000DQLE2 10-100 DQLE700F-8A 200-700 1515 25.4 7.9

No.875 with DQL200N4 No.875 Note 1. DQL200N4 and DQL280N have resin grips.
2. For the model having 25.4mm square drive, use a through-hole socket.
Part # Applicable Model 3. DQLE550N2-DQLE1000N2 have knurled handles.
875 DQL200N4 4. DQLE2 with built-in Adjusting Handle

Adjustable Torque
TW2 Wrench with Multiplier
Assembly Adjustable

• Easy bolt tightening for large vehicle tires


Ratchet Head Graduation Bi-Directional

Direction NEW Accuracy ±5%


Torque Range
Square Drive Weight [kg]
Model [N·m]
Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] Body Torque Wrench
NEW TW750N2 350-750 1.5
5 25.4 20
NEW TW1000N2 400-1000 2.0
Note 1. TW2 is a set of dedicated torque wrench and stand. Standard torque wrench cannot be used.
2. Use through hole type socket for square drive 25.4mm.
3. Socket, pin, and O-ring are sold separately.
4. Applicable height of nut is between 255 and 790mm
Usage Example

TW750N2

Torque Wrench for


MTQL Motorsports
Assembly Adjustable

• Wide capacity adjustable style


Ratchet Head Graduation RoHS

Direction • Ideal for motorcycle & motorbike maintenance


Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
[N·m] Metric [kgf·m] Weight
S.I. Model Length Drive
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
MTQL40N 5-40 0.5 400MTQL 0.5-4 0.05 250 0.45
9.5
MTQL70N 10-70 700MTQL 1-7 285 0.47
MTQL70N 1 0.1
MTQL140N 20-140 1400MTQL 2-14 400 12.7 0.77

Standard Accessories Carrying case


MTQL Optional Accessories

842 846
Carrying Case (P.46)
Applicable Model Weight
Part #
Dimension [mm] [kg]
MTQL40N, MTQL70N
842 0.25
H60 × W400 × D70
MTQL140N
843 0.36
H60 × W520 × D80
MTQL140N and below
846 1.0
H170 × W500 × D100

14
TiQL/TiQLE Assembly Pre-Lock

• 50% lighter than standard wrenches


Ratchet Head Graduation Titanium Material RoHS

Direction Titanium Type Adjustable


• Ideal for working overhead
Torque Wrench Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
Metric Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] Length Drive
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
TiQL kgf·cm kgf·cm
TiQL180N 1800TiQL 494 0.9
40-180 40-1800 20 12.7
TiLQL180N 2 1800TiLQL 594 1.0
TiQL180N kgf·m kgf·m
TiEQL360N 80-360 3600TiEQL 8-36 0.2 987 2.4
19.0
TiQLE N·m N·m kgf·m kgf·m
TiEQLE750N 100-750 5 7500TiEQLE 10-75 0.5 1365 4.5
TiEQLE750N
TiEQLE1400N 200-1400 10 14000TiEQLE 20-140 1 1794 25.4 7.5

Note For the model having 25.4mm square drive, use a through-hole socket.
Standard Accessories 1. Hex key and Color bands for TiQL180N, TiLQL180N and TiEQL360N
2. Adjusting tool for TiEQLE750N, TiEQLE1400N

TiEQLE Optional Accessories

TiQLLS

Torque Wrench for


RoHS
POKA Patrol, Count Checker
CNA-4mk3

Assembly
• TiQL style with Limit Switch output
Adjusting Tool for TiEQLE (P.46) • Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke,
Refer to page 28.
Part # Applicable Model system for assembly processes
301 TiEQLE750N, 1400N
S.I. Model Metric Model
TiQLLS180N 1800TiQLLS
TiLQLLS180N 1800TiLQLLS * Sold separately
TiEQLLS360N 3600TiEQLLS

PHL/PHLE2 Assembly Adjustable Graduation

• Ideal for use with pipes and plumbing applications


Pipe-Wrench Head RoHS

Direction Pipe-Wrench Head Type


Accuracy ±5%
Adjustable Torque Wrench Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Grippable Overall
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Pipe Dia. Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
PHL kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
PHL50N 10-50 0.5 500PHL3 100-500 5 450PHL3-A 100-400 5 316 1.46
lbf·ft lbf·ft
PHL100N 20-100 900PHL3 200-900 900PHL3-A 15-75 472 1.61
PHL140N 1 10 1 13-38
PHL140N 30-140 1400PHL3 400-1400 1400PHL3-A 30-100 530 1.76
PHL200N 40-200 1800PHL3 400-1800 20 1800PHL3-A 30-150 620 2.3
2 kgf·m kgf·m
2
PHL280N 40-280 2800PHL3 4-28 2800PHL3-A 30-200 833 2.92
PHLE1300N2 0.2
PHL420N 60-420 3 4200PHL 6-42 4200PHL-A 60-300 1122 4.83
PHLE2 N·m N·m kgf·m kgf·m lbf·ft lbf·ft
26-52
PHLE850N2 200-850 8500PHLE2 20-85 PHLE600F 150-600 1664 8.2
5 0.5 5
PHLE1300N2 300-1300 13000PHLE2 30-130 PHLE900F 200-900 1831 10

Note 1. PHLE2 Models have extension bar handle.


2. PHL420N, PHLE850N2, and PHLE1300N2 have knurled handles.
3. PHLE2 with built-in Adjusting Handle

Open Ring Head


QRSP Type Preset Torque
Assembly Preset Open Ratchet Head

• Ring head opens to allow fitting on tubes or pipes.


RoHS

Direction Wrench Accuracy ±3%


Torque Range
Overall Length Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm]
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [kg]
QRSP38N×17 300
QRSP38N×19 0.4
10-45 100-450 305
QRSP38N×21
QRSP38N×24 310 0.43
QRSP38N×17
Note A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. QRSP38N×17 × 25N·m

QRSP Optional Accessories


Thrustring Tool for QRSP (P.46)
QRSPLS RoHS

Part # Tool # Applicable Model • QRSP style with Limit Switch output POKA Patrol, Count Checker
312 A-3 QRSP38N • Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke,
system for assembly processes
CNA-4mk3
Refer to page 28.
Model Weight [kg]
QRSPLS38N×17
QRSPLS38N×19 0.4
QRSPLS38N×21
QRSPLS38N×24 0.43 * Sold separately

15
Ratchet Head Type Assembly Pre-Lock Ratchet Head Graduation RoHS
PQL Pre-Lock Torque
Wrench
• External scale, set by a hex key
Direction

PQL100N4
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque RangeOverall Square
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Length Drive
Model Model
PQL Optional Accessories Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
PQL10N 2-10 100PQL 20-100 PQL50l-2A 10-50 0.5
0.1 1 190 6.35 0.19
PQL15N 3-15 150PQL 30-150 PQL100l-2A 20-100 1
PQL25N 5-25 0.25 225PQL 50-250 2.5 225PQL-A 50-200 2.5 215 0.25
9.53
PQL50N 10-50 0.5 450PQL 100-500 5 450PQL-A 100-400 5 260 0.40
lbf·ft lbf·ft
PQL100N4 20-100 900PQL4 200-1000 900PQL4-A 15-75 320 0.65
842 846 1 10 1
PQL140N 30-140 1400PQL 300-1400 1400PQL-A 30-100 385 12.7 0.75
PQL200N4 40-200 1800PQL4 400-2000 20 1800PQL4-A 30-150 2 470 1.40
Carrying Case (P.46) kgf·m kgf·m
Torque Wrench for

2
PQL280N 40-280 2800PQL 4-28 - - - 670 2.0
Applicable Model Weight 0.2 19.05
Part # PQL420N 60-420 4200PQL 6-42 - - - 975 3.4
Dimension [mm] [kg]
Assembly

50N-100N4 Standard Accessories Hex key for torque adjustment


842 0.25
H60 × W400 × D70
140N-200N4
843 0.36
H60 × W520 × D80

846
200N and below
H170 × W500 × D100
1.0 PQLLS • PQL style with Limit Switch output
• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly
847
280N and below
0.36
RoHS processes
H170 × W740 × D100
S.I. Model Metric Model POKA Patrol, Count Checker
PQLLS25N
PQLLS50N
225PQLLS
450PQLLS CNA-4mk3
PQLLS100N4 900PQL4LS
Refer to page 28.
PQLLS140N 1400PQLLS
PQLLS200N4 1800PQL4LS
PQLLS280N 2800PQLLS
Protective Head Cover PQLLS420N 4200PQLLS
Refer to page 46. * Sold separately

Pre-Lock Adjustable
PQLZ Insulated Torque
Assembly Pre-Lock

• Insulated casing prevents electrical shocks.


Ratchet Head Graduation Vinyl Coating

Direction Wrench
• Specialized version of PQL
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm] Weight
S.I. Model Length Drive
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
PQLZ25N 5-25 0.25 225PQLZ 50-225 2.5 227 9.5 0.28
PQLZ100N4 20-100 1 900PQLZ4 200-900 10 340 12.7 0.80
PQLZ100N4
Standard Accessories Hex key for torque adjustment

Preset Insulated
QSPZ Torque Wrench
Assembly Preset Vinyl Coating

• Insulated design suited for use in electric shock hazard conditions


Direction • Ideal for electric car assembly, connection of battery terminal wiring work etc.
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall Square
Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length Drive
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
QSPZ25N 5-25 50-250 50-200 227 9.5 0.28
QSPZ100N4 20-100 200-1000 100-750 334 12.7 0.8

QSPZ25N Note 1. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque adjustment. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. QSPZ100N4 × 80N·m
2. Adjusting tools for QSPZ are sold separately.
3. Sockets are sold separately. Refer to page 41.
4. Sockets are not insulation coating.

Moto Tork/Pre-Lock
MT70N Adjustable Specialty
Assembly Pre-Lock

• Converts basic hand tools into torque wrenches


Interchangeable Graduation RoHS

Direction Torque Wrench


• Ideal for motorcycle maintenance
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Overall
[N·m] Metric [kgf·m] Weight
S.I. Model Length
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
MT70N 10-70 0.2 MT-7 1.0 -7.0 0.02 238 0.65

Note 1. Ring head wrench shown in the photo is not included.


2. Max. clamp width for interchangeable tool is approx. 21mm.
3. Min. interchangeable hex wrench key size is 5mm.
MT70N Standard Accessories 1. Carrying case
2. Hex key wrench for torque adjustment

16
Interchangeable Head Assembly Pre-Lock Interchangeable Graduation RoHS
PCL Type Pre-Lock Torque
Wrench
• Interchangeable head version of PQL
• External scale, set by a hex key
Direction

PCL100N×15D
Interchangeable Head Accuracy ±3%

Tohnichi Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall


Metric American Weight
Head S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in/lbf·ft]
Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
SH AH2 RH lbf·in lbf·in
PCL10N×8D 2-10 100PCL 20-100 PCL50l×8D 10-50 0.5
8D 0.1 1 170 0.16
PCL15N×8D 3-15 150PCL 30-150 PCL100l×8D 20-100 1
10D PCL25N×10D 5-25 0.25 225PCL 50-250 2.5 225PCL-A 50-200 2.5 195 0.22
QH RQH DH 12D PCL50N×12D 450PCL 450PCL-A 100-400 220
10-50 0.5 100-500 5 5 0.32
PCL50N×15D 500PCL 500PCL-A 100-450 225
lbf·ft lbf·ft
15D
PCL100N×15D 20-100 900PCL 200-1000 900PCL-A 15-75 295 0.48
1 10 1
HH PCL140N×15D 30-140 1400PCL 300-1400 1400PCL-A 30-100 355 0.63

Torque Wrench for


SH-N FH
19D PCL200N×19D 40-200 2 1800PCL 400-2000 20 1800PCL-A 30-150 2 435 1.3

Assembly
Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.
PH 2. PH type interchangeable head/p.45 is not applicable.
3. Interchangeable heads are optional.
Standard Accessories Hex key for torque adjustment

PCLLS RoHS

• PCL style with Limit Switch output


• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
S.I. Model Metric Model
PCLLS25N×10D 225PCLLS POKA Patrol, Count Checker
PCLLS50N×12D 450PCLLS
PCLLS50N×15D 500PCLLS CNA-4mk3
PCLLS100N×15D 900PCLLS
PCLLS140N×15D 1400PCLLS Refer to page 28.
PCLLS200N×19D 1800PCLLS

* Sold separately

SCL European Style


Interchangeable Head Type
Assembly Adjustable

• DIN interchangeable head connection


Interchangeable Graduation RoHS

Direction Adjustable Torque Wrench


• Same function of CL
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range
[N·m] Head Size Overall Length Weight
S.I. Model
Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
SCL25N5-9×12 5-25 0.2 226 0.3
SCL50N-9×12 10-50 0.5 9×12 239 0.37
SCL50N-9×12
SCL100N-9×12 20-100 1 313 0.52
SCL200N-14×18 40-200 2 14×18 464 1.2

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. Applicable to European style interchangeable head only. Tohnichi's interchangeable heads are not
available for SCL models.
3. SCL25N5-9 × 12N is a yellow/black resin grip.

European Style
SCSP Interchangeable
Assembly Interchangeable

• DIN interchangeable head connection


Preset RoHS

Direction Head Type Preset


• Same function of CSP
Torque Wrench Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range
Head Size Overall Length Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm]
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
SCSP25N-9×12 5-25 50-250 204 0.15
SCSP50N-9×12 10-50 100-500 9×12 230 0.3
SCSP100N-9×12 20-100 200-1000 302 0.45
SCSP50N-9×12 SCSP200N-14×18 40-200 400-2000 14×18 434 1

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. Applicable to European style interchangeable head only. Tohnichi’s interchangeable heads are not
available for SCL models.

17
Ratchet Head Type Assembly Preset Ratchet Head RoHS
QSP Preset Torque Wrench
• No external scale, torque set by a torque wrench tester
• Ideal for mass production application
Direction

QSP100N4
QSP Optional Accessories Accuracy ±3%

Thrustring Tool (P.46) Torque Range Overall Square


Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in] Length Drive
Part # Tool # Applicable Model
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
310 A-1 1.5N-6N
kgf·cm
311 A-2 12N, 25N
312 A-3 50N-140N QSP1.5N4 0.3-1.5 3-15 2.7-13.2
0.16
313 A-4 200N-280N QSP3N4 0.6-3 6-30 5.3-26.5 165
6.35
314 A-5 420N QSP6N4 1-6 10-60 8.9-53.1 0.19
QSP12N4 2-12 20-120 17.7-106.2 175 0.25
QSP3/QSP-MH Optional Accessories QSP25N3-1/4
5-25 50-250 44.3-221.2 215 0.25
QSP25N3
QSP50N3 10-50 100-500 88.5-442.5 240 9.53 0.4
Torque Wrench for

QSP100N4-3/8
20-100 200-1000 177-885 315 0.65
931 QSP100N4
930 314 QSP140N3 30-140 300-1400 265.5-1239.1 380 0.7
Assembly

QSP200N4 40-200 400-2000 354-1770.1 465 12.7 1.2


Adjusting Tool (P.46)
kgf·m
Part # Applicable Model
QSP280N3-1/2 354-2478.2
931 QSP1.5N4-12N4, QSP25N3/-MH 40-280 4-28 665 1.8
QSP50N3/-MH ~ 280N3/-MH QSP280N3 354-2478.2
930 19.05
QSP100N4/-MH, 200N4/-MH QSP420N 60-420 6-42 531.1-3717.3 970 3.1
314 QSP420N
Note 1. Adjusting tools are sold separately.
2. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. QSP100N4 × 80N·m
3. QSP200N4-QSP420N have knurled handles.

QSPLS • QSP style with Limit Switch output


• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly
RoHS processes
Protective Head Cover Refer to page 29.
Refer to page 46.

QSP-MH Ratchet Head


Type Preset
Assembly Preset

• Knurled metal handle version of QSP


Ratchet Head RoHS

Direction Torque Wrench


• Ideal for oily working conditions
with Metal Handle Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall Square
Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length Drive
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
QSP25N3-MH 5-25 50-250 44.3-221.2 215 0.25
9.5
QSP50N3-MH 10-50 100-500 88.5-442.5 240 0.4
QSP100N4-MH 20-100 200-1000 177-885 315 0.65
12.7
QSP140N3-MH 30-140 300-1400 265.5-1239.1 380 0.7
QSP100N4-MH
Note 1. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque adjustment. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. QSP100N4-MH × 80N·m
2. Adjusting tools for QSP-MH are sold separately.
3. Sockets are sold separately. Refer to page 41.

Bi-Directional Type
BQSP Preset Torque Wrench
Assembly Preset

• Click for both CW & CCW applications


Ratchet Head Bi-Directional RoHS

Direction NEW • Same function of QSP


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall Square Adjusting
Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in] Length Drive Tool
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg] Part #
kgf·cm
NEW BQSP10N 5-10 50-100 44.3-88.5 6.35
213.5 0.2 931
NEW BQSP20N 10-20 100-200 88.5-177
BQSP70N
NEW BQSP40N 20-40 200-400 177-354 240 9.53 0.4
NEW BQSP70N 35-70 350-700 309.8-619.5 314 0.63
NEW BQSP120N 60-120 600-1200 531-1062 380 0.73
BQSP Optional Accessories NEW BQSP220N 110-220 1100-2200 973.5-1947 462
12.7
1.3
930

kgf·m
NEW BQSP300N 150-300 15-30 1327.5-2655 665 2.4
19.05
931 NEW BQSP400N 200-420 20-42 1770-3717 970.5 3.7 314
930 314 Note 1. BQSP10N-300N have resin grips.
2. BQSP400N has a knurled handle.
Adjusting Tool (P.46) 3. Adjusting tool is sold separately.
Part # Applicable Model 4. Sockets are sold separately. Refer to page 41.
931 BQSP10N-20N
930 BQSP40-300N
314 BQSP400N

18
Interchangeable Head Assembly Preset Interchangeable RoHS
CSP Type Preset Torque
Wrench
• Interchangeable head version of QSP
• No external scale, torque set by a
Direction
torque wrench tester CSP100N3×15D
Accuracy ±3%

Tohnichi Torque Range Overall


Weight
Head Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in] Length
Size Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [kg]
CSP Optional Accessories kgf·cm
CSP1.5N4×8D 0.3-1.5 3-15 2.7-13.2
Thrustring Tool (P.46) CSP3N4×8D 0.6-3 6-30 5.3-26.5
130
8D
Part # Tool # Applicable Model CSP6N4×8D 1-6 10-60 8.9-53.1 0.2
165
CSP12N4×8D 2-12 20-120 17.7-106.2
310 A-1 1.5N-6N 10D CSP25N3×10D 5-25 50-250 44.3-221.2 195
311 A-2 12N, 25N 12D CSP50N3×12D 215
312 A-3 50N-140N 10-50 100-500 88.5-442.5 0.3
CSP50N3×15D 220
313 A-4 200N-280N 15D CSP100N3×15D 20-100 200-1000 177-885 290 0.45
314 A-5 420N CSP140N3×15D 30-140 300-1400 265.5-1239.1 350 0.55
19D CSP200N3×19D 40-200 400-2000 354-1770.1 430 1.0
CSP Optional Accessories kgf·m
Adjusting Tool (P.46) CSP280N3×22D 40-280 4-28 354-2478.2 625 1.4

Torque Wrench for


22D
CSP420N×22D 60-420 6-42 531.1-3717.3 920 2.7
Part # Applicable Model
931 CSP1.5N4-12N4, 25N3/-MH Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.

Assembly
930 CSP50N3/-MH ~ 280N3/-MH 2. Adjusting tools are sold separately.
314 CSP420N 3. Interchangeable heads are optional.
4. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. CSP100N3×15D × 80N·m
Interchangeable Head 5. CSP200N3×19D-CSP420N×22D have knurled handles.

SH AH2 RH
CSPLS • CSP style with Limit Switch output
• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly
RoHS processes
Model
POKA Patrol, Count Checker
QH RQH DH CSPMS12N4×8D
CSPLS25N3×10D
CSPLS50N3×12D
CNA-4mk3
CSPLS50N3×15D Refer to page 28.
HH CSPLS100N3×15D
SH-N FH
CSPLS140N3×15D
CSPLS200N3×19D
PH CSPLS280N3×22D
* Sold separately
CSPLS420N×22D

CSP-MH Interchangeable
Head Type
Assembly Interchangeable

• Knurled metal handle version of CSP


Preset RoHS

Direction Preset Torque


• Ideal for oily working conditions
Wrench with Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall
Metal Handle Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Weight

Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [kg]


CSP25N3×10D-MH 5-25 50-250 44.3-221.2 195 0.2
CSP50N3×12D-MH 215
10-50 100-500 88.5-442.5 0.3
CSP50N3×15D-MH 220
CSP100N3×15D-MH 20-100 200-1000 177-885 290 0.45
CSP140N3×15D-MH 30-140 300-1400 265.5-1239.1 350 0.55
CSP100N3×15D-MH
Note 1. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque adjustment. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. CSP100N3×15D-MH × 80N·m
2. Adjusting tools for CSP-MH are sold separately.
3. Sockets are sold separately. Refer to page 41.

Bi-Directional
BCSP Interchangeable Head
Assembly Preset

• Click for both CW & CCW applications


Interchangeable Bi-Directional RoHS

Direction Type Preset Torque


• Same function of CSP
Wrench Accuracy ±3%

Tohnichi Torque Range Overall Effective Adjusting


NEW Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in] Weight
Head Length Length Tool
Size Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg] Part #
kgf·cm
NEW 8D BCSP10N×8D 5-10 50-100 44.3-88.5 189.5 176
0.2 931
NEW 10D BCSP20N×10D 10-20 100-200 88.5-177 192.5 186
NEW BCSP40N×12D 20-40 200-400 177-354 214 208 0.23
12D
BCSP70N×15D NEW BCSP70N×12D 286 280 0.57
35-70 350-700 309.8-619.5
NEW BCSP70N×15D 290 291
15D
NEW BCSP120N×15D 60-120 600-1200 531-1062 348.5 349.5 0.62 930
NEW 19D BCSP220N×19D 110-220 1100-2200 973.5-1947 427 445 1.2
BCSP Optional Accessories kgf·m
NEW BCSP300N×22D 150-300 15-30 1327.5-2655 625 660 2
Adjusting Tool (P.46) 22D
NEW BCSP400N×22D 200-420 20-42 1770-3717 918 950 3.7 314
Part # Applicable Model
931 BCSP10N-20N Note 1. Overall length does not included interchangeable head. Interchangeable heads are optional.
930 BCSP40N-300N 2. BCSP10N-300N have resin grips.
314 BCSP400N 3. BCSP400N has a knurled handle.
4. Adjusting tool is sold separately.
5. Sockets are sold separately. Refer to page 41.

19
Open End/Ring Assembly Preset Open End Spanner ·······SP·SP2/-MH Ring Head ·······RSP2/-MH
SP·SP2/-MH Head Type
Preset Torque
• Various sizes of open end or ring heads fixed on wrench
• Ideal for specific bolt size application
RSP2/-MH Wrench
RoHS RoHS
Direction

SP38N2×27 SP19N2×10-MH

RSP38N2×17 RSP120N2-MH
Accuracy ±3% Accuracy ±3%

Model (Body Size × Width) Torque Range Head Dimension Overall Model (Body Size × Width) Torque Range Head Dimension Overall
Weight Weight
[N·m] [kgf·cm] O.W. × Thickness Length [N·m] [kgf·cm] O.W. × Thickness Length
SP2 SP2-MH Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg] SP/SP2 SP2-MH Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
NEW SP2N2×5.5 - SP160N2×41 SP160N2×41-MH 30-160 300-1600 70×14 386 (386) 0.75
NEW SP2N2×7 - SP220N2×19 SP220N2×19-MH 53×13 448 (447)
Torque Wrench for

23×5
NEW SP2N2×8 - 180 SP220N2×22 SP220N2×22-MH 56×13 451 (450)
NEW SP2N2×10 - SP220N2×24 SP220N2×24-MH 58×13 453 (452)
0.4-2 4-20
Assembly

NEW SP2N2×12 - SP220N2×27 SP220N2×27-MH 61×13 456 (455)


NEW SP2N2×13 - 25×5.5 185 SP220N2×29 SP220N2×29-MH 45-220 450-2200 458 (458) 1.3
63×13
NEW SP2N2×17 - 28×6 190 SP220N2×30 SP220N2×30-MH 460 (460)
NEW SP2N2×19 - 29×8 195 SP220N2×32 SP220N2×32-MH 65×13 464 (464)
NEW SP8N2×7 - 0.15 SP220N2×34 SP220N2×34-MH 67×15 463 (463)
NEW SP8N2×8 - SP220N2×36 SP220N2×36-MH 72×15 468 (467)
NEW SP8N2×9 - 23×5 180 SP310N2×22 SP310N2×22-MH 60×14 647 (646)
NEW SP8N2×10 - SP310N2×24 SP310N2×24-MH 62×14 648 (647)
NEW SP8N2×12 - 1.5-8 15-80 SP310N2×27 SP310N2×27-MH 65×14 651 (650)
25×5.5
NEW SP8N2×13 - 185 SP310N2×30 SP310N2×30-MH 65-310 650-3100 68×14 654 (653) 1.8
NEW SP8N2×19 - 29×8 SP310N2×32 SP310N2×32-MH 70×14 655 (654)
195
NEW SP8N2×24 - 34×8 SP310N2×41 SP310N2×41-MH 80×15 670 (670)
NEW SP8N2×27 - 40×8 200 SP310N2×46 SP310N2×46-MH 85×15 671 (671)
NEW SP19N2×10 SP19N2×10-MH SP420N×27 -
NEW
27×6.5
SP19N2×11 SP19N2×11-MH SP420N×30 -
NEW SP19N2×12 SP19N2×12-MH 210 (206) SP420N×32 -
90-420 900-4200 78×18 840 3.3
NEW SP19N2×13 SP19N2×13-MH 30×6.5 SP420N×34 -
NEW SP19N2×14 SP19N2×14-MH SP420N×35 -
NEW SP19N2×17 SP19N2×17-MH 3.5-19 35-190 31×8 0.2 SP420N×36 -
NEW SP19N2×19 SP19N2×19-MH 33×8 220 (216) SP560N×30 - 81×19
995
NEW SP19N2×21 SP19N2×21-MH 35×8 SP560N×32 - 83×19 4
NEW SP19N2-1×10 SP19N2-1×10-MH 24×12 SP560N×36 - 130-560 1300-5600 87×19 1000
NEW SP19N2-2×10 SP19N2-2×10-MH 24×20 215 (211) SP560N×46 - 97×19 1005
4.5
NEW SP19N2-3×10 SP19N2-3×10-MH 24×15 SP560N×55 - 104×19 1010
NEW SP38N2×8 SP38N2×8-MH 250 (245)
Accuracy ±3%
NEW SP38N2×9 SP38N2×9-MH 31×8
255 (250) Torque Range Head Dimension Overall
NEW SP38N2×10 SP38N2×10-MH Model (Body Size × Width) Weight
[N·m] [kgf·cm] O.W. × Thickness Length
NEW SP38N2×11 SP38N2×11-MH 250 (245)
RSP2 RSP2-MH Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
NEW SP38N2×12 SP38N2×12-MH
NEW RSP8N2×8 - 15×6 200
NEW SP38N2×13 SP38N2×13-MH 2-9 20-90 0.15
NEW RSP8N2×10 - 17.5×7 205
NEW SP38N2×14 SP38N2×14-MH 35×8
255 (250) NEW RSP19N2×8 RSP19N2×8-MH 4-14.1 40-141 15×6 220 (220)
NEW SP38N2×16 SP38N2×16-MH
8-38 80-380 0.35 NEW RSP19N2×10 RSP19N2×10-MH 17.5×7 221 (221) 0.2
NEW SP38N2×17 SP38N2×17-MH 4-21 40-210
NEW RSP19N2×13 RSP19N2×13-MH 22×7 223 (223)
NEW SP38N2×19 SP38N2×19-MH
NEW RSP38N2×10 RSP38N2×10-MH 9-24.2 90-242 17.5×7 244 (244)
NEW SP38N2×22 SP38N2×22-MH 41×8
NEW RSP38N2×12 RSP38N2×12-MH 20.5×8 247 (247)
NEW SP38N2×24 SP38N2×24-MH 43×8 270 (265) 9-29.5 90-295
NEW RSP38N2×13 RSP38N2×13-MH 21.5×8 246 (246)
NEW SP38N2×27 SP38N2×27-MH 45×8 0.35
NEW RSP38N2×14 RSP38N2×14-MH 23.5×9 247 (247)
NEW SP38N2-1×10 SP38N2-1×10-MH 24×12
NEW RSP38N2×16 RSP38N2×16-MH 9-42 90-420 26×9
NEW SP38N2-2×10 SP38N2-2×10-MH 25×20 250 (245) 248 (248)
NEW RSP38N2×17 RSP38N2×17-MH 27.5×9
NEW SP38N2-3×10 SP38N2-3×10-MH 24×15
NEW RSP67N2×14 RSP67N2×14-MH 25×10 312 (311)
NEW SP67N2×14 SP67N2×14-MH 285 (284) 14-59 140-590
NEW RSP67N2×16 RSP67N2×16-MH 27×10 313 (312)
NEW SP67N2×16 SP67N2×16-MH 287 (286)
NEW RSP67N2×17 RSP67N2×17-MH 29×12 0.45
NEW SP67N2×17 SP67N2×17-MH 288 (287) 314 (313)
NEW RSP67N2×18 RSP67N2×18-MH 14-73 140-730 29.5×12
NEW SP67N2×18 SP67N2×18-MH 45×10 289 (287)
NEW RSP67N2×19 RSP67N2×19-MH 30×12 315 (314)
NEW SP67N2×19 SP67N2×19-MH 290 (289)
RSP120N2×17 RSP120N2×17-MH 29.4×12 393 (393)
NEW SP67N2×21 SP67N2×21-MH 292 (291) 24-100 250-1000
RSP120N2×18 RSP120N2×18-MH 30.6×12 394 (393)
NEW SP67N2×22 SP67N2×22-MH 13-67 130-670 293 (292) 0.5
RSP120N2×19 RSP120N2×19-MH 31.8×13 394 (394) 0.8
NEW SP67N2×24 SP67N2×24-MH 46×11 299 (298)
RSP120N2×21 RSP120N2×21-MH 24-120 250-1270 34×13 396 (396)
NEW SP67N2×27 SP67N2×27-MH 303 (301)
50×11 RSP120N2×22 RSP120N2×22-MH 35×13 396 (396)
NEW SP67N2×29 SP67N2×29-MH 304 (303)
RSP160N2×19 RSP160N2×19-MH 32.8×13 395 (394)
NEW SP67N2×30 SP67N2×30-MH 52×11 305 (304)
RSP160N2×21 RSP160N2×21-MH 34×13 396 (395)
NEW SP67N2×32 SP67N2×32-MH 54×11 307 (306) 30-160 320-1700 0.9
RSP160N2×22 RSP160N2×22-MH 35×13 396 (396)
NEW SP67N2×33.3 SP67N2×33.3-MH 57×11 308 (307)
RSP160N2×24 RSP160N2×24-MH 38×15 398 (397)
SP120N2×14 SP120N2×14-MH 42×10 360 (359)
RSP220N2×22 RSP220N2×22-MH 38.4×13 480 (479)
SP120N2×17 SP120N2×17-MH 45×10 362 (361)
RSP220N2×24 RSP220N2×24-MH 45-220 480-2300 40×13 481 (480) 1.5
SP120N2×18 SP120N2×18-MH 46×10 364 (364)
RSP220N2×27 RSP220N2×27-MH 45×13 483 (482)
SP120N2×19 SP120N2×19-MH 47×10 365 (364)
RSP310N2×24 RSP310N2×24-MH 65-255 680-2550 41.8×15 678 (678)
SP120N2×21 SP120N2×21-MH
24-120 240-1200 50×10 368 (367) RSP310N2×27 RSP310N2×27-MH 45×15 680 (680) 2
SP120N2×22 SP120N2×22-MH 65-310 680-3200
RSP310N2×30 RSP310N2×30-MH 50×15 682 (681)
SP120N2×23 SP120N2×23-MH
51×11 369 (368)
SP120N2×24 SP120N2×24-MH Note 1. The value shown in ( ) in the “Overall Length” shows the length of SP2-
0.75 MH models.
SP120N2×27 SP120N2×27-MH 53×12 370 (369)
SP120N2×30 SP120N2×30-MH 55×14 373 (373) 2. Due to a variety of SP2/RSP2 models, specify required inner width,
model name and set torque when you order.
SP160N2×19 SP160N2×19-MH 50×10
Ex. RSP38N2×10 × 16N·m
SP160N2×21 SP160N2×21-MH 51×12 368 (367) 3. Refer to page 46 for thrusting and adjusting tool
SP160N2×22 SP160N2×22-MH 52×12
30-160 300-1600
SP160N2×24 SP160N2×24-MH 53×12 369 (369)
SP160N2×26 SP160N2×26-MH
SP·SP2·RSP2/-MH Optional Accessories
55×12 373 (373)
SP160N2×27 SP160N2×27-MH Thrustring Tool / Adjusting Tool (P.46)

20
Torque Wrench for
SP2-H Piping Work
Assembly Preset Open End Spanner RoHS
• Made with smaller outside width to work in narrow spaces, including hydraulic
Direction piping, where current open-end type is unable to access.
• Aligned with appropriate inner widths commonly used for hydraulic piping
applications.
Accuracy ±3%
Model Torque Range Minimum Head Dimension Overall Adjusting
(Body Size × Width) Weight
[N·m] [kgf·cm] Piping Pitch (O.W. × Thickness) Length Tool
SP38N2×19H SP2-H Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg] Part #
NEW SP38N2×14H 8-25 80-250 26 26.3×8 218
0.37
NEW SP38N2×19H 8-39 80-390 35 33.1×8 222
930
NEW SP67N2×27H 13-67 130-670 46 43.6×11 294 0.48
SP120N2×32H-MH 24-120 240-1200 54 51.6×14 363 0.75

Note 1. Minimum piping pitch is required.


2. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. SP38N2×14H × 25N·m
3. SP120N2×32H-MH is a knurled handle. Others are resin handles.

Thrustring Tool (P.46)

Torque Wrench for


Part # Applicable Model
930 SP38N2-H, SP67N2-H, SP120N2×32H-MH

Assembly
SP2-N/-MH Assembly Preset

• Notch creates speed in tightening process.


Notched Head RoHS

Direction Notched Head Type


• Ideal for brake lines
Preset Torque Wrench
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Head Dimension
NEW Model (Body Size × Width)
[N·m] [kgf·cm] O.W. × Thickness
Overall
Length
Weight
Adjusting
Tool
Head Shape
SP2-N SP2-N-MH Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg] Part #
NEW SP19N2-1×10N SP19N2-1×10N-MH 21×12
NEW SP19N2-3×10N SP19N2-3×10N-MH 21×15 Even
NEW SP19N2-4×10N SP19N2-4×10N-MH 3.5-19 35-190 21×10 203 0.21 931
SP19N2-1×10N NEW SP19N2-5×10N SP19N2-5×10N-MH 21×15 All down
NEW SP19N2-9×10N SP19N2-9×10N-MH 21×10
Even
NEW SP38N2×14N SP38N2×14N-MH 8-38 80-380 32×8 222 0.37 930

Note 1. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. SP19N2-1×10N × 15N·m
2. Adjusting tool for SP19N2-N/-MH is 931 and for for SP38N2-N/-MH is 930.
SP19N2-1×10N-MH

SPLS2-N/-MH
• SP-N style with Limit Switch output
• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Head Dimension Overall Adjusting
Model (Body Size × Width) Weight
[N·m] [kgf·cm] O.W. × Thickness Length Tool
Head Shape
SPLS2-N SPLS2-N-MH Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg] Part #
Head Shape "Even"
NEW SPLS19N2-1×10N SPLS19N2-1×10N-MH 21×12
NEW SPLS19N2-3×10N SPLS19N2-3×10N-MH 21×15 Even
NEW SPLS19N2-4×10N SPLS19N2-4×10N-MH 21×10
3.5-19 35-190 203 0.36 931
NEW SPLS19N2-5×10N SPLS19N2-5×10N-MH 21×15
All down
NEW SPLS19N2-8×10N SPLS19N2-8×10N-MH 21×12
NEW SPLS19N2-9×10N SPLS19N2-9×10N-MH 21×10
Even
NEW SPLS38N2X14N SPLS38N2X14N-MH 8-38 80-380 32×8 222 0.52 930

Note 1. The curl cord length of SPLS19N2-8×10N is about 5m in full extension.


Head Shape "All down" Others are extended to about 2m in full extension.
2. Adjusting tool for SPLS19N2-N/-MH is 931 and for SPLS38N2-N/-MH is 930.
3. The curl cord length of SPLS19N2-8×10N is about 5m in full extension. Others are extended to about
2m in full extension.

NSP100CNx8 Assembly Preset

• Ideal for SMA connector tightening


Open End Spanner Break-Over RoHS

Direction Break-Over Torque Wrench


• 90 degree of “breaking” upon reaching the set torque to reduce
the possibility of over-torque
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range
Model Head Dimension Overall Length Weight
[cN·m]
(Body Size × Width)
Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [kg]
NSP100CN×8 50-100 16×4 128 0.33
NSP100CN×8
Note A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.

NSP Optional Accessories


Thrustring Tool (P.46)
Part # Applicable Model
310 NSP100CN×8

21
Slip Type
QSPCA Torque Wrench
Assembly Preset Ratchet Head
• Cam action mechanism generates a 45 degree “slip” action.
Slip Type RoHS

Direction • No torque variation by gripping point


• Conforms to the Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) standard
Torque Range Overall Square
Weight Accuracy
Model Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Length Drive
[N·m] [kgf·cm] [Ibf·in] [mm] [mm] [kg] [%]
QSPCA6N 2-6 20-60 20-50 ±6%
0.33
QSPCA12N 4-12 40-120 40-100 ±4%
197 6.35
QSPCAMS6N 2-6 20-60 20-50 ±6%
0.45
QSPCA6N QSPCAMS12N 4-12 40-120 40-100
QSPCA30N 10-30 100-300 90-270 267 0.64
QSPCA70N 20-70 200-700 180-620 346 1.24 ±4%
9.53
QSPCALS30N 10-30 100-300 90-270 267 0.81
QSPCALS70N 20-70 200-700 180-620 346 1.41

Note 1. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. QSPCA6N × 5N·m
QSPCA30N 2. Adjusting tools for QSPCA are sold separately.
3. Limit Switch specifications are AC30V below 1A, DC30V below 1A.
4. Standard curl cord can be extended to about 2m in full extension.
Torque Wrench for

5. Female connector for LS cable is sold separately. Part# WA5219K.


6. QSPCA70N and QSPCALS70N have knurled handles.
Assembly

QSPCA70N QSPCAMS/ • QSPCA style with Limit Switch output


• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for
assembly processes
QSPCALS
QSPCA Optional
RoHS POKA Patrol, Count Checker
Accessories

Adjusting Tool (P.46)


931
930
CNA-4mk3
Refer to page 28.
Part # Applicable Model
QSPCA6N, QSPCAMS6N
931
QSPCA12N, QSPCAMS12N
QSPCA30N, QSPCALS30N QSPCAMS6N QSPCAMS12N
930 QSPCA70N, QSPCALS70N
QSPCAFH30N, QSPCAFH70N * Sold separately

QSPCALS30N QSPCALS70N

QSPCAFH • Wireless error-proofing, Pokayoke, system

RoHS Model
QSPCAFH30N
QSPFAFH70N

QSPCAFH30N QSPCAFH70N
Note Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.

YCL2 Two Step Motion


Torque Wrench
Assembly Adjustable

• Two step motion prevents over-torque.


Interchangeable Graduation Two Step Motion RoHS

Direction • Suitable for assembly of critical parts


• Easy torque setting by graduation
• Interchangeable head
Accuracy ±3%
Tohnichi Torque Range Torque Range Max Effective Overall
Torque Range
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm] American Hand
[lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
Head S.I. Model
Force Legthe
Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [N] [mm] [mm] [kg]
YCL90N2×15D lbf·in lbf·in
YCL10N2×10D 5-10 0.10 100YCL2 50-100 1 YCL100I 50-100 1 46.5
10D 215 245 0.35
YCL20N2×10D 10-20 0.20 200YCL2 100-200 2 YCL200I 100-200 2 93
YCL40N2×12D 20-40 0.25 400YCL2 200-400 2.5 YCL400I 200-400 2.5 145.5
12D 275 309 0.53
YCL70N2×12D 35-70 0.50 700YCL2 350-700 5 YCL600I 300-600 5 254.5
YCL90N2×15D 45-90 0.25 900YCL2 450-900 2.5 YCL750I 400-750 2.5
236.8 414 1.05
- - - - - - YCL1000I 600-1000 5
15D 380
lbf·ft lbf·ft
YCL140N2×15D 70-140 1400YCL2 700-1400 YCL100F 45-100 0.5 368.4 414 1.05
0.50 5
YCL180N2×19D 90-180 1800YCL2 900-1800 - - -
19D 310 579 607 1.75
- - - - - - YCL150F 80-150 0.5

22
PRO TORK/
CPT-G Digital Torque
Wrench for
Assembly Digital Interchangeable

• Highly responsive to the applied torque value with indicator display


Signal Battery RoHS

Direction • Equipped with bright LED lamp indicating current torque level
Tightening
• 5 changeable units of measure through keypad set up
• Data memory, torque set registration and output functions

“Torque Wrench Only” Models Accuracy ±3%


Torque Range Overall
Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [kgf·m] [lbf·in] [bf·ft] Length
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg]
CPT20×10D-G 4-20 0.02 40-200 0.2 0.4-2 0.002 36-180 0.2 3-14.5 0.02 280.5 0.63
CPT50×12D-G 10-50 0.05 100-500 0.5 1-5 0.005 100-440 0.5 7.5-36 0.05 282.5 0.65
CPT50×12D-G CPT100×15D-G 20-100 0.1 200-1000 1 2-10 0.01 200-880 1 15-73 0.1 384.5 0.85
CPT200×19D-G 40-200 400-2000 4-20 360-1700 30-150 475.5 1.37
0.2 2 0.02 0.2 0.2
CPT280×22D-G 56-280 560-2800 5.6-28 500-2400 42-200 591.5 1.76

Note 1. “Torque Wrench Only” version is provided in basic carton product box and does not include TQH Head,
Batteries, Storage Case.
2. "Overall Length" does not include the length of interchangeable head TQH.
3. "Weight" does not include the weight of interchangeable head TQH and batteries.
4. Interchangeable heads are sold separately. Refer to page 42-45.

Torque Wrench for


CPT100×15D-G
“Set” Models including Accessories

Assembly
Standard Accessory
Ratchet Head
Model
Sq. Drive Battery Storage Case
Model
[mm]
CPT20×10D-G-SET TQH10D
9.5
CPT50×12D-G-SET TQH12D AA Alkaline Small
How to Order: CPT100×15D-G-SET TQH15D Battery
12.7
CPT200×19D-G-SET TQH19D (2 pcs)
Large
[Ex. 1] CPT100×15D-G-SET CPT280×22D-G-SET TQH22D 19.0
* “Set” model version Note Recommendation: Use 2xAA Ni-MH batteries for longer continuous use.

with standard accessories


[EX. 2] CPT200×19D-G CPT-G Common Specifications
* “Torque Wrench Only” version Accuracy ±3% of indicated value
Tightening Direction Clockwise/Counter clockwise
without standard accessories
14 segment LCD 6 digits/7mm
Display/Character Height
7 segment LCD 4 digits/3mm
Battery Life Indicator 4 steps
Number of Data Memory 50
Preset Tightening mode: 10 torque values to register
CPT-G Optional Accessories Torque Setting Memory
Judgment Tightening mode: Up to 10 values of each Upper/Lower/Tightening direction
Auto power off ( 3 minutes)
Auto memory/Reset
Basic Function
Auto zero
Over torque alarm
Power AA battery × 2pcs
Continuous Use approx. 40 hours
Operating Condition 0-40 Celsius below 85%RH (no condensation)

844

Carrying Case for "SET" model only Several different tightening modes available to cater to a variety of applications.
Part #
Applicable Model
Dimension [mm]
Weight
[kg]
Quick and accurate tightening while preventing errors.
844
CPT20×10D-G ~ CPT100×15D-G
H170 × W500 × D100
1.0 Modes include:
CPT200×19D-G, CPT280×22D-G Preset Tightening Mode, Judgment Tightening Mode, Peak/Run Modes
845 1.6
H170 × W740 × D100 * Retightening/loosening torque is performed in the Peak Mode.
Preset Tightening Mode: Allows user to set the target torque with specific % of
torque allowable beyond target, then the red LED moves towards the right to
indicate the level of the applied torque. When it reaches the target torque range,
the blue LED blinks and the buzzer signals tightening completion.
Judgment Tightening Mode: Allows user to set judgment ranges for lower/upper
585 Connecting to CPT-G limit in the tightening operation. Upon tightening completion a judgment is made
as torque value is stored in the memory.
Connecting Cable
Part # Applicable Model
585 CPT-G ➝ PC (D-Sub 9 Pin Female) Display example 1 Display example 2 Display example 3

Data Processing Software Preset Tightening Mode Judgment Tightening Mode Judgment Tightening Mode
Model Red LED shows the level of the As torque is being applied prior to The case of exceeding target torque
EXCEL RECEIVER applied torque completion range

23
Digital Torque Assembly Digital Interchangeable Signal Re-Chargeable RoHS
CTA2-G and Angle
Wrench
• Snug and angle setting functions
• Buzzer/Light alerts to snug torque and angle completion
Direction NEW • Angle mode activates automatically, once snug torque is achieved.
Accuracy ±1%
CTA100N2×15D-G Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Angle Measuring Overall Interchan
Angle Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Range Length geable
Accuracy
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg] Head
kgf·cm kgf·cm kgf·m kgf·m lbf·in lbf·in lbf·in lbf·in
NEW CTA50N2×12D-G (2.5) 10-50 0.05 (25) 100-500 0.5 (0.25) 1-5 0.005 (22.5) 100-450 0.5 (1.85) 7.5-36.5 0.05 ±2°+1digit 282 0.58 QH12D
NEW CTA100N2×15D-G (5) 20-100 0.1 (50) 200-1000 1 (0.5) 2-10 0.01 (45) 200-900 1 (3.8) 15-75 0.1 (Angular 384 0.63 QH15D
NEW
velocity is
CTA200N2×19D-G (10) 40-200 0.2 (100) 400-2000 2 (1) 4-20 0.02 (88) 350-1750 2 (7.5) 30-150 0.2 475 0.78 QH19D
0-999° 1° 30°/X~180°/
NEW CTA360N2×22D-G (18) 72-360 0.4 (180) 720-3600 4 (1.8) 7-36 0.05 (159) 640-3150 (13) 52-260 0.5 713 1.13
5 s when the QH22D
NEW CTA500N2×22D-G (25) 100-500 0.5 (250)1000-5000 5 (2.5) 10-50 0.05 (220) 880-4400 (18) 72-360 0.5 949 4
bolt turned to
NEW CTA850N2×32D-G (43) 170-850 1.0 - - (4.3) 17-85 0.1 - - (31) 124-620 1 90°) 1387 5.14 QH32D
CTA500N2×22D-G
Note 1. The value shown in ( ) shows the lowest snug torque. Accuracy cannot be guaranteed for snug torque
set beyond the operative torque range.
2. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.
3. PH (Pipe wrench head) type interchangeable head cannot be used with this model.
4. CTA500N2×22D-G and CTA850N2×32D-G have knurled handles.
Torque Wrench for

Standard Accessories Battery pack/BP-5, QH interchangeable head (P.44), Quick battery charger/BC-3-G (100-240V), cable/584
Assembly

CTA2 Optional Accessories


CTA2-G Features 2 Tightening Modes: Single Spindle and Production Tightening
Modes
Battery Pack (P.47)
Model 1. Single Spindle Tightening Mode: For angle method tightening of a single bolt
BP-5 tightening with snug torque, tightening angle and tightening angle upper limit
Quick Battery Charger (P.47) settings.
Model Voltage
BC-3-G 100-240V
2. Production Tightening Mode: For angle method tightening of multi spindle,
with tightening torque, snug torque, 1st, 2nd and 3rd tightening angle, each
Printer (P.65) upper limited angle, the numbers of spindles are registered.
Model
EPP16M3 By using the included software package, various settings can be done through
Connecting Cable (P.47) the PC and transferred to the wrench with the final tightening values being sent
Part # Applicable Model back to an Excel spreadsheet.
575 CTA2-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3 (D-SUB 9 Pin Female)
584 CTA2-G ➝ PC (USB A Type)
Note 1. ( ) shows pin shape of the
connecting cables.
2. Contact Tohnichi for other types of
connecting cables.

Carrying Case (P.46)


Applicable Model
Model Weight [kg]
Dimention [mm]
CTA50N2×12D-G,
846 CTA100N2×15D-G 1.0
H170 × W500 × D100
Single spindle tightening mode setting display Production tightening mode setting display
CTA200N2×19D-G,
847 CTA360N2×22D-G 1.6
H170 × W740 × D100

Output data in single spindle tightening mode Output data in production tightening mode

CTA2-G Common Specifications


Data Memory 999 data (Tightening torque, 1st angle value, 2nd angle value, 3rd angle value and final torque value)
Measurement Mode Single spindle/Production mode
Data Output RS232C compliant
Zero Adjustment Auto zero (Angle, Torque)
Power Ni-MH rechargeable battery
Continuous Use approx. 20 hours with fully charged (8 hours by 1 hour recharging)
Recharging Time approx. 3.5 hours
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40

Snug torque, Tightening torque, Max. tightening torque, 1st, 2nd, 3rd angle, 1st, 2nd, 3rd max. angle,
Other Functions
Number of bolts, Auto reset, Judgment, Setting through PC, Battery indicator

24
DWQL Analog Torque
Wrench with Digital
Assembly Adjustable Digital Ratchet Head

• Easily apply snug torque with "click" followed by angle with integrated digital
Graduation RoHS

Angle Module
angle display.
• Digital angle starts once snug torque setting is achieved.
• Correct angle is calculated and shown even when ratcheting feature is used.
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall
Angle Range Angle Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] Length
DWQL100N Accuracy
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg]
DWQL50N (5) 10-50 0.5 260 0.62
±2°+1digit
DWQL100N (10) 20-100 1 335 0.86
(Angular velocity
DWQL140N (25) 30-140 400 1.00
0-999° 1 is 30°/s-180°/s
DWQL200N (30) 40-200 490 1.6
2 when the bolt is
DWQL280N (30) 40-280 695 2.2
turned to 90°.)
DWQL420N (40) 60-420 995 3.6

Note 1. The capacity values in the ( ) are minimum setting values for snug torque, but these values are not
within guaranteed accuracy range.
2. A value in the ( ) might not be exact same when purchased M-DW is installed on LS torque wrench.
3. Certificates of calibration for both torque and angle are included.
4. Prior to use, confirm final applied torque value do not exceed max torque of the tool.

Torque Wrench for


Assembly
M-DW
• Convert torque wrench with limit switch to angle torque wrench by installing
M-DW.
Digital Angle Module
Model Description
M-DW Angle module for torque wrench with limit switch

Note 1. M-DW can be installed on torque wrench with limit switch except for the following models: QSPCALS,
ALS, ACLS, and MS type torque wrench, Refer to page 29.
2. Operate within torque range of installed torque wrench.
3. Cerlificate of angle calibration is attached.

M-DW Specifications
* M-DW shows 20° from snug torque.
Range of Angle 0-999°
1digit 1°
Angle Accuracy ±2°+1digit (Angular velocity is 30°/s-180°/s when the bolt is turned to 90°.)
Display 7 segments LED, 3 digits/Character height 10mm
Continuous Operation approx. 60 hours
Operating Condition 0-40°C Below 85%RH (no condensation)
Limit switch with connector 1 pc.
Standard Accessories Screw & Washer: 2 pcs. per each
Operating instruction, AAA battery: 1 pc.
Weight 0.12kg

• Torque wrench with Limit Switch is converted to digital angle torque wrench.

Step 2. Put M-DW on LS type torque wrench.


Step 1. Remove Limit
Switch.

Torque wrench with Limit Switch Step 3. Torque wrench with Digital Angle Module

Analog Torque and


WQL Angle Wrench
Assembly Dial Indicating Ratchet Head

• Includes built-in protractor with flexible arm


Graduation Angle Direct Reading RoHS

Direction • Specialized version of QL


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Square Overall Angle
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Scale
S.I. Model Drive Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] Max. Grad.
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
WQL50N (5) 10-50 0.5 450WQL3 (50) 100-500 0.5 450WQL3-A (40) 100-400 5 9.5 260
lbf·ft lbf·ft
WQL100N4 (10) 20-100 1 900WQL4 (100) 200-1000 1 900WQL4-A (7) 15-75 1 345
12.7 360° 2°
WQL200N4 (30) 40-200 1800WQL4 (300) 400-2000 2 1800WQL4-A (20) 30-150 2 495
kgf·m kgf·m
2
WQL280N (30) 40-280 2800WQL3 (3) 4-28 2800WQL3-A (20) 30-200 2 695
0.2 19.0
WQL420N (40) 60-420 4200WQL2 (4) 6-42 4200WQL2-A (30) 60-300 3 975
WQL100N4 Note 1. The capacity value in the ( ) are minimum setting value for snug torque, but this value is not within
guaranteed accuracy range.
2. WQL Models are supplied upon request.

25
Assembly Pre-Lock Ratchet Head Graduation Quick Drying Ink RoHS
MPQL/MQL • Mechanism marks bolt as torque is achieved.
Marking Torque • Requires special socket, marker and ink
Direction
Accuracy ±3%
Wrench
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Length
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
MPQL50N 10-50 0.5 450MPQL 100-500 5 450MPQL-A 100-400 5 246 0.7
lbf·ft lbf·ft
MPQL100N4 20-100 900MPQL4 200-1000 900MPQL4-A 15-75 320 0.95
MPQL100N4 1 10 1
MPQL140N 30-140 1400MPQL 400-1400 1400MPQL-A 30-100 385 1.1
MPQL200N4 40-200 1800MPQL4 400-2000 20 1800MPQL4-A 30-150 418 1.8
2 kgf·m kgf·m 2
MQL280N 40-280 2800MQL3 4-28 0.2 2800MQL3-A 30-210 692 2.6

Note Please choose a Tohnichi's original socket with width which matches your bolt size, and order it together
with the torque wrench. Standard sockets can not be used.
Marked bolts Standard Accessories Hex key for torque adjustment
Torque Wrench for
Assembly

Marking Torque
MQSP Wrench
Assembly Preset

• Mechanism marks bolt as torque is achieved.


Ratchet Head Quick Drying Ink RoHS

Direction • Preset style of MPQL


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Overall
Weight
Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Length
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [g]
MQSP50N 10-50 100-500 88.5-442.5 240 0.7
MQSP100N 20-100 200-1000 177-885 315 1.0
MQSP140N 30-140 400-1400 265.5-1239.1 380 1.1
MQSP200N 40-200 400-2000 354-1770.1 465 1.8

Note 1. Please choose a Tohnichi original socket with width matches your bolt size, and order it together with
the torque wrench. Standard sockets can not be used.
MQSP100N 2. A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque adjustment. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. MQSP50N × 30N·m
3. Adjusting tools for MQSP are sold separately.
4. MQSP200N has knurled handles.

Marking Torque
CMQSP Wrench
Assembly Preset

• Preset style marking torque wrench for hex screws


Ratchet Head Quick Drying Ink RoHS

Direction • Mechanism marks side of bolt and work piece.


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Width Overall
[N·m] Across Flat Weight
S.I. Model Length
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [kg]
CMQSP-M6 5-25 5 0.85
241
CMQSP-M8 10-50 6 0.85
CMQSP-M8
CMQSP-M10 20-100 8 320 1.13
CMQSP-M12 30-140 10 380 1.13

Marked bolt head Note A torque wrench tester is necessary for torque setting. Specify required set torque when you order.
Ex. CMQSP-M10 × 50N·m
Standard Accessories 2 x Hex wrench (including 1 spare), Marker head, Marker case, Hex wrench position adjustment tool

CMQSP Optional Accessories


Bit CMQSP Adjusting Adapter
Part # Description Part # Description Applicable Tester
724 CMQSP-M6 Bit 811 CMQSP-M6 Adapter
DOTE20N3-G, 50N3-G, 100N3-G
725 CMQSP-M8 Bit 812 CMQSP-M8 Adapter
726 CMQSP-M10 Bit 813 CMQSP-M10 Adapter
DOTE200N3-G, 500N3-G
727 CMQSP-M12 Bit 814 CMQSP-M12 Adapter

Marker Head CMQSP Adjusting Pole Holder


Part # Description Part # Applicable Model Applicable Tester
792 Marker Head for CMQSP 815 CMQSP-M6, M8 Pole Holder DOTE20N3-G, 50N3-G, 100N3-G
816 CMQSP-M10, M12 Pole Holder DOTE200N3-G, 500N3-G

Refill Ink and Solvent Note A torque wrench tester, Tohnichi's Adjusting Adapter, and Pole Holder are necessary for CMQSP torque
adjustment.
Part # Description
776 White Ink CMQSP Adjusting Tool (P.46)
777 Yellow Ink Part # Applicable Model
794 Solvent 930 CMQSP-M6, M8, M10, M12

26
MPQL/MQL/MQSP Optional Accessories
Socket
Applicable
Width Across Length H Outside Width Applicable
Model Part # Torque T-max
Flat [mm] [mm] φd [mm] Model
[N·m]
NEW Socket 4MH-10 2700 10 17.5 25
NEW Socket 4MH-12 2701 12 20.5 35
NEW Socket 4MH-13 2702 13 21.5 40
NEW
100
Socket 4MH-14 2703 14 22.5 60
NEW Socket 4MH-16 2704 16 25 70 MQSP/MPQL
NEW Socket 4MH-17 2705 17 28 110 50N-200N4
No.2700 No.2704 No.2720 NEW Socket 4MH-18 2706 18 29 120
No.2701 No.2705 No.2721 NEW Socket 4MH-19 2707 19 30 170
No.2702 No.2706 No.2722 NEW Socket 4MH-22 2709 22 105 30 190
No.2703 No.2707 No.2723 NEW Socket 4MH-24 2710 24 32.8 200
No.2712 No.2709 NEW Socket 6MH-22 2720 22 32 255
No.2713 No.2710 NEW Socket 6MH-24 2721 24 34.5 255
No.2714 No.2715 NEW
MQL280N
Socket 6MH-27 2722 27 110 38.5 255
No.2716 NEW Socket 6MH-30 2723 30 42 280
No.2717

Torque Wrench for


Inch Size Socket

Assembly
Width AcrossFlat Tmax Outside
Length H Applicable
Model Part # [lbf·in] Width φd
[inch] [mm] [mm] Model
(N·m) [mm]
NEW Socket 4MH-7/16 2712 7/16 11.113 300(35) 20
NEW Socket 4MH-1/2 2713 1/2 12.7 400(45) 21
NEW
100
Socket 4MH-9/16 2714 9/16 14.288 700(80) 23 MQSP/MPQL
NEW Socket 4MH-5/8 2715 5/8 15.875 800(90) 25.5 50N-200N4
NEW Socket 4MH-11/16 2716 11/16 17.463 1000(120) 28.5
105
NEW Socket 4MH-3/4 2717 3/4 19.05 1500(170) 30

Marker Head
No.1780 No.1782 No.2780 No.2782
Marking Diameter
Model Part # Color
[mm]
Marker Head MK53RB 1780 Red, Blue
Marker Head MK53WY 1782 White, Yellow
NEW
5
Marker Head MK53RB-MG 2780 Red, Blue
NEW Marker Head MK53WY-MG 2782 White, Yellow
NEW Marker Head MK93RB-MG 2783 Red, Blue
9
NEW Marker Head MK93WY-MG 2785 White, Yellow
Note 1. MK53-MG and MK93-MG, 2780-2785, come with a marker guide
2. Use MK53-MG for socket below 16mm, 2700-2704.
3. 1780 and 1782 are not applicable for socket below 16mm, 2700-2704.
4. Use MK93-MG for socket over 17mm, 2705-2723.
5. 1780 and 1782 with marker guide, 2786, are applicable for socket over 17mm, 2705-
No.2783 No.2785 No.2786
2723.

Marker Guide
Marking Diameter
Model Part # Content
[mm]
NEW Marker Guide 2786 - -
NEW Marker Guide set MK53RB 2787 1780 and 2786
5
NEW Marker Guide set MK53WY 2788 1782 and 2786
No.776
No.777 No.1770 Note 2787 and 2788 are applicable for socket over 17mm, 2705-2723.
No.794 No.1771
Refill Ink and Solvent
Model Part # Color
Refill Ink R 1770 Red
Refill Ink B 1771 Blue
Refill Ink W 776 White
Refill Ink Y 777 Yellow
Solvent 794 For White and Yellow
Note 1. Solvent for red and blue inks is not available.
2. Refill Ink and solvent are classified as hazardous material in Aviation law.
No.1775 No.775 No.1776 No.1777
Replacement Tip
Model Part # Color
Felt tip for MK53RB 1775 Red, Blue
Felt tip for MK53WY 775 White, Yellow
Felt tip for MK93RB 1776 Red, Blue
Felt tip for MK93WY 1777 White, Yellow
Note Sold in pack of ten tip

Extension Bar
Model Part # Applicable Model
MPQL Extension Bar 50mm 1749 MPQL50N-200N4
No.1749 No.1748 No.1752 MPQL Extension Bar 100mm 1748 MQSP50N-200N
MQL Extension Bar 50mm 1752 MQL280N

MPQL/MQSP Torque Adjusting Adapter


Model Part # Applicable Model Applicable Tester
No.817 MQSP 3/8-17 Adapter 817
MPQL50N
DOTE50N3
No.818 MQSP50N
MPQL100N4-200N4 DOTE100N3
MQSP 1/2-17 Adapter 818
MQSP50N-200N DOTE200N3

MQSP Adjusting Tool


Part # Applicable Model
No.930 930 MQSP50N/100N/200N

27
Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, System
Counter Method

Examples) QL/QLE2 (P.12), CL/CLE2 (P.13), TiQL/TiQLE (P.15), PQL (P.16), QRSP (P.15), PCL (P.17), QSP (P.18),
QSPCA (P.22), CSP (P.19), SP·SP2·RSP2/-MH(P.20), SP2-N/-MH (P.21), AUR (P.48),
Wired A/AC2 (P.50)
Control the number of
tightening to eliminate
missed tightening
QSPCAMS12N RTDLS120CN
QLLS100N4

Wired

Wired
Torque Wrench for

SPLS38N2×17 ACLS100N2
CNA-4mk3/
Assembly

Count Checker
Wireless
Wired
+ +
QLLS25N5 QLLS25N5

T-FHSLS256 T-BLA/BLE
R-BL
Modified to… Modified to… Receiver

Wireless
Wired Bluetooth®
R-BT
QLFHSLS25N5 QLBL25N5 Receiver
Wireless

QLFH100N4
HAC100N
Wireless
RTDFH120CN R-FH256
QSPCAFH30N Receiver
Examples) FH transmitter (P.30) mounted on torque wrench such as QL
Equipped with FH functions such as HATFH (P.49)
Note : Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.

Marking Method (P.26)

MPQL100N4 MNTD MNTD Marking

Visually check the bolt


CMQSP-M8 marked to recognize torque
tightening completion

CNA-4mk3 Assembly Digital

• Tightening number verification counter


Relay Counter Judgment RoHS

POKA Patrol/ • Max. 4 LS torque wrenches can be connected as one time.


Count Checker Count Display 16 × 32 dot-matrix LEDs
30 × 25 square display lamp (commonly used for OK/NG)
OK/NG Judgment Display OK: Blue lamp turned on
NG: Red lamp blinking + Buzzer sounds (4 patterns)
Work No. Selection Display 1-digit 7-segment LED
Count Input Contact input × 4
Max. Tightening Number of Bolts 99 counts
Max. Number of Works 8 sets
OK/NG Judgment Setting • Preset judgment, • END input judgment, • Automatic judgment (0 to 300 seconds in steps of 1 second)
• OK/NG output (Relay contact output rating: 30 V DC, 1 A, 125 V AC, 0.3 A)
Output Function
• Torque wrench selection signal output (Open collector rating: 100 mA)
Input Function • SELECT input × 4, • START input, • END input, • RESET input, • WORK SENSOR input
• Double count prevention timer (0 to 10 seconds in steps of 0.1 second)
Timer Function Setting • Automatic reset timer (0 to 60 seconds in steps of 1 second)
• Interval warning timer (0 to 99 seconds in steps of 1 second)
CNA-4mk3 Setting Method Special-purpose application software (USB communication), key operation
Operating Condition 0 ~ 40 [°C], Below 85%RH (no condensation)
Power Supply AC [V] / Electricity Consumption [W] 100 ~ 240V ± 10% 50/60Hz, Below 10
Weight / Dimension approx. 400g, W121 × D175 × H44.9mm

28
• Limit switch counts the number of "Clicks".
Torque Wrench • Connect to PLC or Count Checker/CNA-4mk3 to build verification system
• Can be upgraded into wireless output system by installing T-FHSLS256
with Limit Switch
Limit switch specifications
AC30V Below 1A
DC30V Below 1A

QLLS25N5 QLLS100N4 SPLS38N2×17

QL type with LS RoHS QSP type with LS RoHS PQL type with LS RoHS
S.I. Model Metric Model Model S.I. Model Metric Model
QLMS2N-MH 20QLMS-MH QSPMS12N4 PQLLS25N 225PQLLS
QLMS5N-MH 50QLMS-MH QSPLS25N3 PQLLS50N 450PQLLS
QLMS10N-MH 100QLMS-MH QSPLS50N3 PQLLS100N4 900PQL4LS
QLMS10N 100QLMS QSPLS100N4 PQLLS140N 1400PQLLS
QLMS15N 150QLMS QSPLS140N3 PQLLS200N4 1800PQL4LS
QLMS15N-MH 150QLMS-MH QSPLS200N4 PQLLS280N 2800PQLLS
QLLS25N5 225QL5LS QSPLS280N3 PQLLS420N 4200PQLLS

Torque Wrench for


QLLS50N 450QL3LS QSPLS420N
QLLS100N4 900QL4LS PCL type with LS RoHS
CSP type with LS RoHS

Assembly
QLLS140N 1400QL3LS S.I. Model Metric Model
QLLS200N4 1800QL4LS Model PCLLS25N×10D 225PCLLS
QLLS280N 2800QL3LS CSPMS12N4×8D PCLLS50N×10D 450PCLLS
QLLS420N 4200QL2LS CSPLS25N3×10D PCLLS50N×12D 500PCLLS
CSPLS50N3×12D PCLLS100N×15D 900PCLLS
CL type with LS RoHS CSPLS50N3×15D PCLLS140N×15D 1400PCLLS
S.I. Model Metric Model CSPLS100N3×15D PCLLS200N×19D 1800PCLLS
CLMS2N×8D-MH 20CLMS-MH CSPLS140N3×15D
CLMS5N×8D-MH 50CLMS-MH CSPLS200N3×19D TiQL type with LS RoHS
CLMS10N×8D-MH 100CLMS-MH CSPLS280N3×22D Model Metric Model
CLMS10N×8D 100CLMS CSPLS420N×22D TiQLLS180N 1800TiQLLS
CLMS15N×8D 150CLMS TiLQLLS180N 1800TiLQLLS
QLMS15N×8D-MH 150CLMS-MH QRSP type with LS RoHS TiEQLLS360N 3600TiEQLLS
CLLS25N5×10D 225CL5LS Model
CLLS50N×12D 450CL3LS QRSPLS38N×17 QSPCA type with LS RoHS
CLLS100N×15D 900CL3LS QRSPLS38N×19 Model
CLLS140N×15D 1400CL3LS QRSPLS38N×21 QSPCAMS6N
CLLS200N×19D 1800CL3LS QRSPLS38N×24 QSPCAMS12N
CLLS280N×22D 2800CL3LS QSPCALS30N
CLLS420N×22D 4200CL2LS SP2/-MH type with LS RoHS QSPCALS70N
Model (Body Size × Width)
SP2/-MH type with LS RoHS RSP2/-MH type with LS RoHS
SPLS2 SPLS2-MH
Model (Body Size × Width) NEW SPLS38N2-3×10 SPLS38N2-3×10-MH Model (Body Size × Width)
SPMS2/SPLS2 SPLS2-MH NEW SPLS67N2×14 SPLS67N2×14-MH RSPMS2/RSPLS2 RSPLS2-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×5.5 - NEW SPLS67N2×16 SPLS67N2×16-MH NEW RSPMS8N2×8 -
NEW SPMS2N2×7 - NEW SPLS67N2×17 SPLS67N2×17-MH NEW RSPMS8N2×10 -
NEW SPMS2N2×8 - NEW SPLS67N2×18 SPLS67N2×18-MH NEW RSPLS19N2×8 RSPLS19N2×8-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×10 - NEW SPLS67N2×19 SPLS67N2×19-MH NEW RSPLS19N2×10 RSPLS19N2×10-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×12 - NEW SPLS67N2×21 SPLS67N2×21-MH NEW RSPLS19N2×13 RSPLS19N2×13-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×13 - NEW SPLS67N2×22 SPLS67N2×22-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×10 RSPLS38N2×10-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×17 - NEW SPLS67N2×24 SPLS67N2×24-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×12 RSPLS38N2×12-MH
NEW SPMS2N2×19 - NEW SPLS67N2×27 SPLS67N2×27-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×13 RSPLS38N2×13-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×7 - NEW SPLS67N2×29 SPLS67N2×29-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×14 RSPLS38N2×14-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×8 - NEW SPLS67N2×30 SPLS67N2×30-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×16 RSPLS38N2×16-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×9 - NEW SPLS67N2×32 SPLS67N2×32-MH NEW RSPLS38N2×17 RSPLS38N2×17-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×10 - NEW SPLS67N2×33.3 SPLS67N2×33.3-MH NEW RSPLS67N2×14 RSPLS67N2×14-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×12 - SPLS120N2×14 SPLS120N2×14-MH NEW RSPLS67N2×16 RSPLS67N2×16-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×13 - SPLS120N2×17 SPLS120N2×17-MH NEW RSPLS67N2×17 RSPLS67N2×17-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×19 - SPLS120N2×18 SPLS120N2×18-MH NEW RSPLS67N2×18 RSPLS67N2×18-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×24 - SPLS120N2×19 SPLS120N2×19-MH NEW RSPLS67N2×19 RSPLS67N2×19-MH
NEW SPMS8N2×27 - SPLS120N2×21 SPLS120N2×21-MH RSPLS120N2×17 RSPLS120N2×17-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×10 SPLS19N2×10-MH SPLS120N2×22 SPLS120N2×22-MH RSPLS120N2×19 RSPLS120N2×19-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×11 SPLS19N2×11-MH SPLS120N2×23 SPLS120N2×23-MH RSPLS120N2×22 RSPLS120N2×22-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×12 SPLS19N2×12-MH SPLS120N2×24 SPLS120N2×24-MH RSPLS160N2×19 RSPLS160N2×19-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×13 SPLS19N2×13-MH SPLS160N2×19 SPLS160N2×19-MH RSPLS160N2×22 RSPLS160N2×22-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×14 SPLS19N2×14-MH SPLS160N2×21 SPLS160N2×21-MH RSPLS160N2×24 RSPLS160N2×24-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×17 SPLS19N2×17-MH SPLS160N2×22 SPLS160N2×22-MH RSPLS220N2×22 RSPLS220N2×22-MH
NEW SPLS19N2×19 SPLS19N2×19-MH SPLS160N2×24 SPLS160N2×24-MH RSPLS220N2×24 RSPLS220N2×24-MH
NEW SPLS19N2X21 SPLS19N2×21-MH SPLS160N2×26 SPLS160N2×26-MH RSPLS220N2×27 RSPLS220N2×27-MH
NEW SPLS19N2-1×10 SPLS19N2-1×10-MH SPLS160N2×27 SPLS160N2×27-MH RSPLS310N2×24 RSPLS310N2×24-MH
NEW SPLS19N2-2×10 SPLS19N2-2×10-MH SPLS220N2×19 SPLS220N2×19-MH RSPLS310N2×27 RSPLS310N2×27-MH
NEW SPLS19N2-3×10 SPLS19N2-3×10-MH SPLS220N2×22 SPLS220N2×22-MH RSPLS310N2×30 RSPLS310N2×30-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×8 SPLS38N2×8-MH SPLS220N2×24 SPLS220N2×24-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×9 SPLS38N2×9-MH SPLS220N2×27 SPLS220N2×27-MH SP2-N/-MH type with LS RoHS
NEW SPLS38N2×10 SPLS38N2×10-MH SPLS220N2×29 SPLS220N2×29-MH Model (Body Size × Width)
NEW SPLS38N2×11 SPLS38N2×11-MH SPLS220N2×30 SPLS220N2×30-MH SPLS2-N RSPLS2-N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×12 SPLS38N2×12-MH SPLS220N2×32 SPLS220N2×32-MH NEW SPLS19N2-1×10N SPLS19N2-1×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×13 SPLS38N2×13-MH SPLS220N2×34 SPLS220N2×34-MH NEW SPLS19N2-3×10N SPLS19N2-3×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×14 SPLS38N2×14-MH SPLS220N2×36 SPLS220N2×36-MH NEW SPLS19N2-4×10N SPLS19N2-4×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×16 SPLS38N2×16-MH SPLS310N2×22 SPLS310N2×22-MH NEW SPLS19N2-5×10N SPLS19N2-5×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×17 SPLS38N2×17-MH SPLS310N2×24 SPLS310N2×24-MH NEW SPLS19N2-8×10N SPLS19N2-8×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×19 SPLS38N2×19-MH SPLS310N2×27 SPLS310N2×27-MH NEW SPLS19N2-9×10N SPLS19N2-9×10N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×22 SPLS38N2×22-MH SPLS310N2×30 SPLS310N2×30-MH NEW SPLS38N2×14N SPLS38N2×14N-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×24 SPLS38N2×24-MH SPLS310N2×32 SPLS310N2×32-MH
NEW SPLS38N2×27 SPLS38N2×27-MH SPLS310N2×41 SPLS310N2×41-MH
NEW SPLS38N2-1×10 SPLS38N2-1×10-MH SPLS310N2×46 SPLS310N2×46-MH
NEW SPLS38N2-2×10 SPLS38N2-2×10-MH

Note 1. Refer to base model series for torque ranges and wrench specs. 3. Standard curl cord can be extended to about 2m in full extension.
2. Female connector for LS cable is sold separately. Part# WA5219K. 4. The curl cord length of SPLS19N2-8×140N is about 5m in full extension.

29
• Wireless error-proofing, Pokayoke, system
FH256MC • FHSS technology with universal 2.4GHz frequency band
• Wrench ID transfer functions to establish bolt tightening traceability
Radio Frequency Torque
Wrench System • Easily change frequency with wireless setting box, SB-FH256

RoHS FH Torque Wrench Examples


QLFH FH transmitter mounted on QL SPFH FH transmitter mounted on SP
S.I. Model Model
QLFH25N5 SPFH38N2×14
QLFH50N SPFH38N2×27
QLFH100N4 QLFH100N4
QLFH140N QSPCAFH FH transmitter mounted on QSPCA
QLFH200N4 Model
QSPCAFH30N
QSPCAFH70N

QLFH25N5
Transmitter RoHS
Model Description Dimension [mm]
T-FH256MC Transmitter for FH256MC W36 × D80 × H18
T-FHSLS256 Transmitter for LS type wrench W32.4 × D56 × H22.3
Torque Wrench for

Note T-FHSLS256 is a wireless transmitter module to be installed on LS type torque


T-FH256MC T-FHSLS256 wrenches.
Assembly

Receiver RoHS
All kinds of frequency groups (256 kinds) can be set in one receiver.
Model Specification
Output: No-Voltage contact output (1a), RS232C
R-FH256 Size: W150 × D210 × H51 (mm), Weight 1.7kg
Power: AC100V-240V, 47-63Hz

Standard Accessories Dipole antenna

Setting Box RoHS


Wireless setting device for FH transmitter and receiver
R-FH256 Model Specification
SB-FH256 Input: RS232C, Power: DC9V
SB-FH256
Standard Accessories Dipole antenna

Multi I/O Box RoHS


Manage 4 tightening signals from receiver and output to external device
Model Applicable Model Specification
I/O-FH256 R-FH256 Output: No-Voltage contact output (1a) × 4, Power: AC100-240V

Antenna Extension Cord


Extends antenna from R-FH256 receiver to improve communication conditions
I/O-FH256
Model Applicable Model Specification
FH-COD R-FH256 Cable Length: approx. 9.5m

Magnetic Antenna Holder


Use this to fix the position of extended antenna
FH-COD Model Applicable Model Specification
FH-MHD R-FH256 Cable Length: approx. 1.5m

Protective Cover
Put it on the transmitter (T-FH256MC and T-FHSLS256) to protect from physical damage.
Model Applicable Model Specification
FH-MHD FH-PCV T-FH256MC
Material: Silcon Resin
FHSLS-PCV T-FHSLS256
Note 1. Transmission distance 10-20 meters
2. Refer to base model series for torque ranges and wrench specs.
FH-PCV 3. Refer to condition of wireless equipment in each country.

*the United States and Canada Only


• 900 MHz frequency wireless error-proofing torque system
FMA • FHSS Technology decreases interference and increases signal capacity
Radio Frequency Torque Wrench System • Transmission Distance 10-20 Meters/30-60 Feet
• Easily change frequency with wireless setting box, SB-FMA

Transmitter, Receiver, and Setting Box


Model Description Specifications
T-FMA Transmitter for R-FMA 900MHz (902.5 - 927.5MHz)
R-FMA Receiver for T-FMA 250kHz interval, 80CH,
SB-FMA Setting box approx. 10 - 20m / 30 - 60 feet operating distance

Note 1. Radio frequency communication errors may be caused by noise or a shield placed between the transmitter
and receiver. In addition, radio waves reflected by metal, concrete, etc. may interfere with radio waves
directly sent to the antenna of the receiver and dead point occurs, resulting in communications errors.
2. Available only in the United States and Canada.

R-FMA

30
Battery Less Wireless Torque • Radio frequency torque wrench system with solar power generation
BL Wrench • No battery replacement
• Chargeable under level of illuminance 200lx.
• Great for the environment
QLBLA *QL with T-BLA QLBLE *QL with T-BLE
S.I. Model S.I. Model
QLBLA25N5/QLBLE25N5 QLBLA25N5 QLBLE25N5
QLBLA50N QLBLE50N
QLBLA100N4 QLBLE100N4
QLBLA140N QLBLE140N
QLBLA200N4 QLBLE200N4

Note Available in USA and Canada only Note 1. Available in EU and China only
2. As for China, soon-to-be-released.
Contact Tohnichi.
QLBLA100N4/QLBLE100N4
SPBLA *SP with T-BLA SPBLE *SP with T-BLE
Model Model
SPBLA38N2×14 SPBLE38N2×14
SPBLA38N2×27 SPBLE38N2×27

Note Available in USA and Canada only Note 1. Available in EU and China only

Torque Wrench for


2. As for China, soon-to-be-released.
T-BLA/T-BLE Contact Tohnichi.

Assembly
Transmitter
Model Description Dimension [mm]
T-BLA BLA Transmitter for USA and Canada
W34.4 × D73 × H23.2mm
T-BLE BLE Transmitter for EU and China

Note 1. T-BLA/BLE can be installed on LS type torque wrench.


T-BLA T-BLE
2. LED on the side of transmitter to check communication status
3. As for T-BLE for China, soon-to-be released. Contact Tohnichi.

Receiver
Model Description Dimension [mm]
R-BLA BLA Receiver for USA and Canada
W121 × D174 × H46mm
R-BLE BLE Receiver for EU and China

Note 1. Simultaneous reception from multiple torque wrenches cannot be done.


2. It transmits relay signal up to 4 torque wrenches.
3. As for R-BLE for China, soon-to-be released. Contact Tohnichi.
Standard Accessary Dipole Antenna

AC Adaptor for R-BLA and R-BLE


Model Description Cable length
BA-8 AC adaptor / AC100V-240V approx. 2m
R-BLA R-BLE

Specifications of T-BLA/BLE and R-BLA/BLE


Approved Market USA and Canada EU and China
Transmitter Receiver Transmitter Receiver
Model
T-BLA R-BLA T-BLE R-BLE
Frequency 902.875MHz 868.3MHz
Moduration Method FSK ASK
Moduration Speed 125kbps
BA-8 ID 8 digits ID /Non-modifiable
Output: Relay ×4, RS232C Output: Relay ×4, RS232C
Recommended Indoor Light Levels Input/Output - -
Input: Reset-in, LS-in Input: Reset-in, LS-in
DC24V/18 ~ 36V DC24V/18 ~ 36V
Power Supply Solar cell Power consumption: Less than 5W Solar cell Power consumption: Less than 5W
Antenna Whip antenna Dipole antenna Helix antenna Dipole antenna
Supermarkets, Mechanical workshops
Operating Temperature [°C] 0 ~ 40
Office work, PC work,
Communication Distance 10 - 20m
Study library, Groceries, Show rooms,
Laboratories Acquisition of License FCC/USA, IC/Canada CE/EU, CMIIT/China
Office, Class room
Warehouses, Homes, Theaters
The ISO standard ISO 8995-1:2002
(CIE 2001/ISO 2002) states that in the
areas where continuous work is carried
out the maintained work place
illuminance should not be less than
200 lx.

Conditions of Wireless Equipment Certification Acquisition


Country Authority Acquisition Condition
Japan TELEC FH256MC, FHSLS, FHS, FMA, BL, FD, CEM3-G-BT, ST2-BT, ST3-G-BT, STC2-G-BT
United States FCC FH256MC, FHSLS, BLA, FMA, FD, CEM3-G-BT, ST2-BT, ST3-G-BT, STC2-G-BT
Canada IC FH256MC, FHSLS, BLA, FMA, FD, CEM3-G-BT, ST3-G-BT, STC2-G-BT
EU CE FH256MC, FHSLS, BLE, *FD, CEM3-G-BT, ST3-G-BT, STC2-G-BT
China SRRC FH256MC, FHSLS, FHS, *BLE, * FD, CEM3-G-BT
Thailand NTC FH256MC, FHSLS, FD, CEM3-G-BT, ST2-BT, ST3-G-BT, STC2-G-BT
Malaysia SIRIM FH256MC, FHSLS, FD
Indonesia SDPPI FH256MC, FHSLS, FD
South Korea KCC FH256MC, *FHSLS, *FD
Taiwan NCC FH256MC, FHSLS, FD
Russia FSB FH256MC, *FD, CEM3-G-BT
India WPC FH256MC
South Africa ICASA FH256MC
Note 1. Contact Tohnichi for condition of certification acquisition for other countries.
2. *soon-to-be certified

31
Tightening Data Management System
Wired transfer of actual applied torque
Ideal for tightening torque traceability system
Tohnichi Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Model Overall Length
Head [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft]
Size [mm]
CSPD Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max.
kgf·cm kgf·m lbf·in lbf·ft
10D CSPD25N3×10D 5-25 50-250 0.5-2.5 44.3-221.2 3.69-18.45 195
12D CSPD50N3×12D 215
10-50 100-500 1-5 88.5-442.5 7.38-36.9
CSPD50N3×15D 220
15D CSPD100N3×15D 20-100 200-1000 2-10 177.0-885.0 14.76-73.8 290
CSPD140N3×15D 30-140 300-1400 3-14 265.5-1239.1 22.14-103.32 350
19D CSPD200N3×19D 40-200 400-2000 4-20 354.0-1770.1 29.52-147.6 430
CSPD280N3×22D 40-280 400-2800 4-28 354.0-2478.2 29.52-206.64 627
22D
CSPD420N×22D 60-420 600-4200 6-42 531.1-3717.3 44.28-309.9 920
Torque Wrench for

Note 1. Initial torque setting is required. Specify required set torque when you order.
2. Display, CD5, is required. CD5's max torque display is 25000.
3. Cable between CSPD and CD5 is selectable between 1m and 4m.
Assembly

4. Interchangeable head is sold separately.


Display Cable
Model Description Dimension [mm] Model Description Plug
CD5 Display W150 × D190 × H94 383 CD5 - PC D-SUB Pin Female

Note Refer to page 64 for more information.

Outline
Wired system features highly reliable transmitter mounted on a click torque wrench that captures actual applied torque data.
CD-5 display shows actual tightening torque and judgment is made whether or not the torque is within the programmed hi/lo
parameters. Connect to PLC and PC software to store and control data for increased tightening reliability.

System
Wired Data Transfer Torque Wrench Wired Data Transfer Semi-Automatic Airtork
Model: CSPD with QH head Model: ACQSPD
Wired transfer of actual tightening torque Wired transfer of actual tightening torque
with operation of provisional tightening

CSPD * Interchangeable head is sold separately.


ACQSPD

Wired

Upper limit Tightening torque value


Wired
Lower limit

CD5
Refer to P.64.

Wired

Balance of spindle Record


Number of spindle
PC connecting cable/383
Refer to P.47.
OK/NG judgement
Red: NG Blue: OK

External device
PLC or PC

32
Tightening Data Management System
Wireless transfer of actual applied torque
Ideal for tightening torque traceability system
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Interchan
Model Weight
[N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Length geable
FD FDD Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg] Head
kgf·cm kgf·cm kgf·m kgf·m lbf·in lbf·in lbf·ft lbf·ft
CSPFD25N3-10N×10D CSPFDD25N3-10N×10D 2-10 20-100 0.2-1 20-85 0.5 1.5-7.5
0.1 1 0.01 193 0.32 QH10D
CSPFD25N3×10D CSPFDD25N3×10D 5-25 50-250 0.5-2.5 50-200 1 3.6-18
0.1
CSPFD50N3×12D CSPFDD50N3×12D 214 QH12D
10-50 0.2 100-500 2 1-5 0.02 100-400 2 7.5-36 0.46
CSPFD50N3×15D CSPFDD50N3×15D 217
CSPFD100N3×15D CSPFDD100N3×15D 20-100 0.5 200-1000 5 2-10 0.05 200-850 5 15-75 0.2 290 0.65 QH15D
CSPFD140N3×15D CSPFDD140N3×15D 30-140 - - 3-14 - - 25-100 0.5 349 0.77
CSPFD200N3×19D CSPFDD200N3×19D 40-200 1 - - 4-20 0.1 - - 30-150 429 1.2 QH19D
1
CSPFD280N3×22D CSPFDD280N3×22D 40-280 - - 4-28 - - 30-200 627 1.65 QH22D
1. FD and FDD are available on request.

Torque Wrench for


Note
2. FDD comes with double tightening detection function.
3. Interchangeable head is sold separately.

Assembly
4. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.
5. Transmission distance 10-20 meters

Receiver Setting Box


Model Description Dimension [mm] Model Description Dimension [mm]
R-FHD256 Receiver for FD/FDD W110 × D48 × H150 SB-FH256 Setting of FD/FDD transmitter & receiver W160 × D120 × H35
Note Power cable is 1.4m. Note 1. It is applicable to existing products.
Standard Accessories Dipole Antenna, RS232C 2. There are several versions in wireless
communication. Contact Tohnichi as regards
Protective Cover the versions.
Model Applicable Model Specification
FD-PCV FD, FDD Material: Silicon Resin

FD/FDD Transmitter Specifications


R-FHD256 SB-FH256 Model FD FDD
Double Tightening Detection Angle Range 0 - 360°
Blue: OK judgment for tightening torque Blue: OK judgment for tightening torque and double tightening
LED Red: NG judgment for tightening torque Red: NG judgment for tightening torque and double tightening
Red flashing: Transmitting error Red flashing: Transmitting error
Tightening torque-3 digits, Torque unit, Tightening torque/angle convertible 3-digits, Torque unit,
LCD Display
Battery level/4 levels Battery level/4 levels
Operation Key POWER switch, TEST switch, SET switch
FD-PCV
Operating Time 24 hrs 12 hrs
Other Functions Auto zero, Auto power off/0-99 mins.
Outline
FD/FDD transmitter on click torque wrench captures actual applied torque and transmits data to receiver, R-FHD256.
Connection to PLC and PC software allows for management of fastener count, serial number, torque ID and judgment parameters.

System
Wireless Data Transfer Torque Wrench
Model: CSPFD

CSPFD
LCD Display
Wireless
(Duplex
communication)
Upper limit Tightening torque value
Lower limit
NG OK

Related Product
Wireless Data Transfer Semi-Automatic Torque Wrench Receiver
Model: HACQSPDY50N R-FHD256
*Customized data transfer version of HAC. Refer to page 49.
Wired Balance of spindle Record
Number of spindle
Transferring torque
data
Wired

External device
Bluetooth®
HACQSPDY50N PLC or PC
R-BT

33
Tightening Data Management System
Wireless Digital Torque Wrench
Model: CEM3-G-BTD/Duplex communication

Ideal for managing tightening data


in cell-production or sub-assembly lines
Merit
• Preventing tightening errors such as missed tightening and over torque by setting upper/lower limit on a digital torque wrench
• Traceable for product claims
• Managing actual applied torque value used in the assembly lines
• Reducing potential costs associated the additional checks and reworks
Torque Wrench for

Outline
Assembly

"CEM3-G-BTD" provides duplex wireless transfer of data between the wrench and PC. "CEM3-G-BTD + Management
software" adds additional duplex functionality by sending set torque value, fastener quantity, and judgments to the wrench for
various tightening applications. One digital torque wrench can replace several manual preset click torque wrenches with the
additional benefit of storing the actual applied torque. Upper/Lower limit can be set on a digital torque wrench from PC with a
duplex communication. As a result, reducing operative cost and time becomes possible.

System
Instantly send tightened torque Upper/Lower limit can be set wirelessly
data back to PC from PC to torque wrench.

Wireless Digital Torque Wrench


CEM3-G-BTD Duplex communication
Lower Torque Limit
Tightened Torque Value

Upper Torque Limit


Judgment LED

OK: Blue
NG: Red

RoHS
Accuracy ±1%
Bluetooth® Specification Torque Range
Tohnichi Head Model Overall Length Weight
Communication Method Bluetooth® [N·m]
Size
Radio Frequency Range 2.4GHz Simplex Communication Duplex communication Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg]
Communication Distance approx. 10m 8D CEM10N3×8D-G-BTS CEM10N3×8D-G-BTD 2-10 0.01 212 0.54
Continuous Use approx. 8 hours 10D CEM20N3×10D-G-BTS CEM20N3×10D-G-BTD 4-20 0.02 214 0.55
12D CEM50N3×12D-G-BTS CEM50N3×12D-G-BTD 10-50 0.05 282 0.66
15D CEM100N3×15D-G-BTS CEM100N3×15D-G-BTD 20-100 0.1 384 0.71
19D CEM200N3×19D-G-BTS CEM200N3×19D-G-BTD 40-200 0.2 475 0.86
CEM360N3×22D-G-BTS CEM360N3×22D-G-BTD 72-360 0.4 713 1.21
22D
CEM500N3×22D-G-BTS CEM500N3×22D-G-BTD 100-500 0.5 949 4.08
Handy Terminal 32D CEM850N3×32D-G-BTS CEM850N3×32D-G-BTD 170-850 1 1387 5.22

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


Compact data collection device 2. Refer to pages 42-45 for details with interchangeable heads.
for CEM3-G-BT 3. PH (Pipe wrench head) is not applicable due to difference of effective length.
• Upload & download torque 4. Bluetooth® adapter (optional) is necessary if your PC is not compatible.
measuring information 5. Consult Tohnichi for management software (optional) for data setting and processing.
• Guides user through torque assembly & quality 6. CEM3-G-BT models have two types.
inspection processes Simplex communication (BTS): CEM3-G-BT ➝ Transfer measurement data to PC
Duplex communication (BTD): Set torque and upper/lower limits in PC ➝ CEM3-G-BT ➝ Transfer
• Statistics and charting capabilities
measurement data to PC
• Contact Tohnichi for lithium battery shipping
7. Standard CEM3-G is unable to be modified into CEM3-G-BT.
specifications. 8. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.
Standard Accessories Battery pack/BP-5, Quick charger/BC-3-G, QH interchangeable head (P.44)

34
Tightening Data Management System
Wireless Digital Torque Wrench
Models: HT-S5 & CEM3-G-BTS/Simplex communication
Software: TDMS

Ideal for tightening torque inspection.


The inspection data management becomes economically and easily possible with Excel®.
Merit
• Reduced overtime due to early detection such as overtorque and loosening torque.
• Monitored data can be used for proof in protection against product liability.
• The degree of wear and the tendency of the tools can be predicted.
• Preventing defects in a large quantity of products.

Torque Wrench for


Outline

Assembly
"CEM3-G-BTS" provides wireless transfer of data from the wrench to PC as it is being applied or collected.
All data can be managed in a master data file consisting of Excel® and torque data can be easily monitored and stored.
In order to maintain high quality, it is important to establish standard values, and then track and manage with statistical
processing. Tightening work can be conducted with portion master file which can be controlled by Excel®. [N], [X-bar], [σ], [cp],
and [cpk] are automatically calculated and stored in an Excel® file.

System
* Wired connection is
also available.

Digital torque wrench


CEM3-G-BTS
Bluetooth®
Refer to P.34.

・Handy terminal
Up to 7 wireless tools ・Bluetooth®-enable device USB Memory PC
can be connected.
[Output Excel® Data Example]
• A data of [N], [X-bar], [σ], [cp], and [cpk] is monitored in Excel® file.

          
M

• More detailed information available.

                      

Note
[Excel®] is a trademark registration of Microsoft Co., Ltd.
[Bluetooth®] is a trademark registration of Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

Model Description Language System Requirements


TDMS Japanese Microsoft Windows XP (SP3)
TDMS-E Software only English Operation System Microsoft Windows Vista 32bit (SP1)
TDMS-C Chinese Microsoft Windows 7 32bit version
TDMSHT Japanese CPU speed 300MHz
Software +
TDMSHT-E English CPU Intel Pentium/Celeron, AMD K6/Athron/Duron
Handy Terminal/HT-S5
TDMSHT-C Chinese RAM 126MB
Recommended Hard Disk Capacity 2.1GB
Note
1. Software installation is allowed on a single PC at one time.
Hardware Display Super VGA 800 × 600
2. Applicable digital torque wrench is CEM3-G-BTS. Refer to page 34. Drive CD-ROM or DVD drive
Communication Bluetooth® (2.0+EDR) SSP profile compliant or SSP profile compliant module
USB USB2.0 × 1

35
DATA TORK/ Inspection Digital Interchangeable Direct Reading Re-Chargeable RoHS
CEM3-G Digital Torque
Wrench
• Dual LED & LCD displays for optimal viewing
• 999 memory storage capacity
Direction
• For inspection and tightening

CEM100N3×15D-G CEM20N3×10D-G CEM850N3×32D-G

Accuracy ±1%
Common Specifications Torque Range Hand Overall
Weight
7 segments LED 4 lines 10mm (Torque value) Model N·m kgf·cm kgf·m lbf·in lbf·ft Force Length
14 segments LCD 3 lines 7mm (Counter) Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit [N] [mm] [kg]
Display 7 segments LCD 4 lines 3mm (Clock) CEM10N3×8D-G 2-10 0.01 20-100 0.1 0.200-1.000 0.001 20.0-90.0 0.1 1.50-7.30 0.01 48.1 212 0.46
Battery life indicator (4 steps) CEM20N3×10D-G 4-20 0.02 40-200 0.2 0.400-2.000 0.002 36.0-180.0 0.2 3.00-14.50 0.02 92.2 214 0.47
Judgment LED RED/BLUE CEM50N3×12D-G 10-50 0.05 100-500 0.5 1.000-5.000 0.005 100.0-440.0 0.5 7.50-36.00 0.05 196.9 282 0.58
Number of Data Memory 999 (M-2 mode: 99 data) CEM100N3×15D-G 20-100 0.1 200-1000 1 2.00-10.00 0.01 200-880 1 15.0-73.0 0.1 275.5 384 0.63
Communication RS232C (2400-19200bps) CEM200N3×19D-G 40-200 0.2 400-2000 2 4.00-20.00 0.02 360-1700 2 30.0-150.0 0.2 428.3 475 0.78
Functions Serial output corresponding to a USB connecter CEM360N3×22D-G 72-360 0.4 720-3600 4 7.2-36.00 0.04 650-3100 4 52.0-260.0 0.4 498.6 713 1.13
Power Supply Ni-MH rechargeable battery CEM500N3×22D-G 100-500 0.5 1000-5000 5 10.00-50.00 0.05 890-4400 5 73.0-360.0 0.5 549.5 949 4.00
Continuous Use approx. 20 hrs with fully charged (8 hours by 1 hour recharging)
CEM850N3×32D-G 170-850 1 - - 17.0-85.0 0.1 - - 124-620 1 608 1387 5.14
Recharging Time approx. 3.5 hours
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40 Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.
2. For interchangeable head, refer to page 42-45.
Peak Hold, Auto memory & resetting, Tightening
3. For infrared data transfer, use with R-DT999. Refer to page 64.
Basic Functions completion buzzer, Judgment of measured data,
4. PH Pipe wrench head type interchangeable head is not available for this model.
Auto zero setting, Auto off (3 minutes), Clock 5. CEM500N3×22D-G and CEM850N3×32D-G have knurled handles.
6. For USB data transfer, use optional connecting cable, No.584. Refer to page 47.
Torque Wrench for
Quality Inspection

Standard Accessories 1. Battery pack/BP-5


2. QH interchangeable head. Refer to page 44.
3. Quick battery charger/BC-3-G (100-240V).

CEM3-P RoHS
• Programmable version of CEM3-G with data management software that links
work name with test results.
Torque Accuracy ±1%
Max. 100 parts (Part name, number of screws, tightening direction, high/low torque, measuring
Portion Registration Memory
order)
Up to 3,000 screw data (vary depending on parts registered), measurement part name, measured
Measurement Data Storage
value, pass/fail judgment, measurement time and date)

CEM50N3×12D-P
Display part
Left: Part name, Right: Torque value

CEM3-P application software

Model Model Model


CEM10N3×8D-P CEM100N3×15D-P CEM500N3×22D-P
CEM20N3×10D-P CEM200N3×19D-P CEM850N3×32D-P
CEM50N3×12D-P CEM360N3×22D-P

Battery Pack (P.47) Connecting Cable (P.47)


Handy Terminal Model
BP-5
Part #
575
Applicable Model
CEM3-G, CEM3-P, R-DT999 ➝ PC, EPP16M3
584 CEM3-G, CEM3-P, R-DT999G ➝ PC
Compact data collection device Quick Battery Charger (P.47)
for CEM3-G Model Description
Data Filing System (P.64)
• Upload & download torque Model Media
BC-3-G 100V-240V
measuring information DFS CD-ROM
• Guides user through torque assembly & quality
inspection processes
Printer (P.65)
• Statistics and charting capabilities Model
• Contact Tohnichi for lithium battery shipping EPP16M3
specifications.

36
CTB2-G Digital Retightening
Torque Wrench
• Detects movement of fastener for more accurate testing
Inspection Digital Interchangeable Signal Re-Chargeable RoHS

Direction • Software converts measured torque to initial tightening torque value. Accuracy ±1%
Torque Range Hand Overall
Weight
Model N·m kgf·cm kgf·m lbf·in lbf·ft Force Length
Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit [N] [mm] [kg]
CTB10N2×8D-G 2-10 0.01 20-100 0.1 0.2-1 0.001 20-90 0.1 1.5-7.3 0.01 48.1 212 0.46
CTB20N2×10D-G 4-20 0.02 40-200 0.2 0.4-2 0.002 36-180 0.2 3-14.5 0.02 92.2 214 0.47
CTB100N2×15D-G CTB50N2×12D-G 10-50 0.05 100-500 0.5 1-5 0.005 100-440 0.5 7.5-36 0.05 196.9 282 0.58
CTB100N2×15D-G 20-100 0.1 200-1000 1 2-10 0.01 200-880 1 15-73 0.1 275.5 384 0.63
CTB200N2×19D-G 40-200 0.2 400-2000 2 4-20 0.02 360-1700 2 30-150 0.2 428.3 475 0.78
CTB360N2×22D-G 72-360 0.4 720-3600 4 7.2-36 0.04 650-3100 4 52-260 0.4 498.6 713 1.13
CTB850N2×32D-G CTB500N2×22D-G 100-500 0.5 1000-5000 5 10-50 0.05 890-4400 5 73-360 0.5 549.5 949 4.00
CTB850N2×32D-G 170-850 1 - - 17-85 0.1 - - 124-620 1 608 1387 5.14

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. For interchangeable head, refer to page 42-45.
Common Specifications 3. For infrared data transfer, use with R-DT999. Refer to page 64.
4. PH type interchangeable head is not available for this model.
Data Memory 999 data (T-point torque)
Arithmetic Function Sampling, Maximum, Minimum, Means Standard Accessories 1. Battery pack/BP-5
Measurement Mode Peak/Run 2. QH interchangeable head (P.44).
3. Quick battery charger/BC-3-G, 100-240V
Data Output RS232C I/F, USB serial output
Zero Adjustment Auto zero function (C key)
Other Function Auto power off (3 min./10 min./30 min./non) Battery Pack (P.47) Printer (P.65)
Power Source Ni-MH Nickel metal-hydride battery Model Model
Continuous Use approx. 20 hours (8 hours by 1 hour charging) BP-5 EPP16M3
Battery Charge approx. 3.5 hours
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40 Connecting Cable (P.47)
Quick Battery Charger (P.47)
Part # Applicable Model
Model Description 575 CTB2-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3
BC-3-G 100-240V 584 CTB2-G, R-DT999G ➝ PC

Torque Wrench for


Data Filing System (P.64)

Quality Inspection
Model Media
DFS CD-ROM

Advantages of the New Retightening Method: T-point Method


• Anyone can measure the tightening torque easily.
• Requires less time to perform the measurement.
• Dispersion of data is small (Figure-3).
• No individual interpretation or performance variable is involved in measuring
the torque (Figure-3).
• Internal software converts measured torque to initial tightening torque value
(Figure-3).

Figure-1 Traditional retightening torque Retightening Torque Method


method Retightening torque method aims to measure the torque at which a tightened
bolt start to rotate again as further torque is applied. The retightening measured
Traditional retightening torque
T C point
values are classified as one of these three kinds:
• The torque which overcome the static friction of the bolt (A point).
A point • The torque at which the bolt starts on turn continuously (B point).
Tightening Torque

• The maximum torque at this inspection (C point).


Tt
B point
Proposal of T-point method (Figure-2)
Retightening torque first starts with the rotation of the head only, then the screw
starts to rotate. Shifting from static friction to dynamic friction, the friction
whip settles and the torque starts to increase at the steady pace again. T-point
method figures TT as retightening torque value.

Figure-2 New retightening torque method by CTB2-G Figure-3 Distribution of retightening torque

Tightening torque (Tt) T-point method (T-point)


Tightening process Retightening inspection
Tightening torque

Retightening torque by bottom method (B point)


Retightening torque by peak
method (A, C point)

Unstable Stable

Refer to Tohnichi Torque Handbook Vol. 8 on page 42 to 43 for the details.

37
Inspection Dial Indicating Direct Reading RoHS
DB/DBE/DBR • Memory pointer for easy torque reading
Dial Indicating Torque • Ideal for torque measuring and quality check applications
Direction Accuracy ±3%
Wrench Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m/kN·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft]Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in

DB1.5N4-S 0.2-1.5 0.02 15DB4-S 2-15 0.2 DB13I-2AS 0-13 0.2

DB12N4 DB3N4-S 0.3-3 0.05 30DB4-S 3-30 0.5 DB26I-2AS 0-26


0.5 205 0.4
DB6N4-S 0.6-6 0.1 60DB4-S 6-60 1 DB40I-2AS 0-40 6.35

DB12N4-S 1-12 0.2 120DB4-S 10-120 2 DB75I-2AS 0-75 1

DB25N-1/4-S 230DB3-1/4-S DB150I-2AS


3-25 30-250 0-150 2 245
DB100N
DB25N-S 230DB3-S DB150I-3AS

0.5 5 0.6
DB300I-3AS 0-300 5

DB50N-S 5-50 450DB3-S 50-500 lbf·ft lbf·ft 320

DB25F-3AS 0-25 0.5


9.5
DBE700N lbf·in lbf·in

DB600I-3AS 0-600 10

DB100N-3/8-S 900DB3-3/8-S lbf·ft lbf·ft

DB50F-3AS 0-50 0.5

10-100 1 100-1000 10 lbf·in lbf·in 400 0.7


Torque Wrench for
Quality Inspection

DB600I-4AS 0-600 10

DB100N-S 900DB3-S lbf·ft lbf·ft

DB50F-4AS 0-50 0.5

DB200N-S 20-200 2 1800DB3-S 200-2000 20 DB100F-4AS 0-100 1 500 12.7


Memory Pointer, Red color point
kgf·m kgf·m 1.0

- - - - - - DB175F-4AS 0-175 2 580

DB280N-1/2-S 2800DB3-1/2-S - - -
30-280 3-28 690 1.65
DB Optional Accessories DB280N-S 2800DB3-S DB250F-6AS 0-250
5 0.5 5
DB420N-S 40-420 4200DB2-S 4-42 DB350F-6AS 0-350 890 2.5
19.0
DBE560N-S 50-560 5600DBE2-S 5-56 - - - 1100 4.0

DBE700N-S 70-700 7000DBE2-S 7-70 DB500F-6AS 0-500 10 1260 5.5

DBE850N-S 100-850 10 8500DBE2-S 10-85 1 - - - 1360 6.1


846
DBE1000N-S 100-1000 10000DBE2-S 10-100 DB800F-8AS 0-800 1490 6.4
10 25.4
Carrying Case (P.46) DBE1400N-S 200-1400 14000DBE2-S 20-140 DB1000F-8AS 0-1000 1740 8.6
Applicable Model Weight 20 2
Part #
Dimension [mm] [kg] DBE2100N-S 200-2100 21000DBE2-S 20-210 DB1500F-8AS 0-1500 2140 12.8
DB100N-S, CDB100N×15D-S or less 20
846 1.0
H170 × W500 × D100 DBE2800N-S 300-2800 50 28000DBE2-S 30-280 DB2000F-12AS 0-2000 2380 16.8

DB280N-S, CDB280N×22D-S or less kN·m kN·m 38.1


847 1.6
H170 × W740 × D100 5
DBR4500N-S 0.5-4.5 0.05 45000DBR-S 50-450 DB3000F-12AS 0-3000 50 1285 26.5

DBR6000N-S 0.6-6 0.1 60000DBR-S 60-600 - - - 1585 44.5 27.5

Note 1. “Without memory pointer” models are available. Remove “-S” from the model name when ordering.
Ex. DB100N
2. DBR models require winch or mechanical loading device.
3. DBR Models are supplied upon request.
4. For models having over 25.4mm square drive, use with a through-hole socket.
5. Accuracy of American models is warranted from 20% of max. torque.

38
Interchangeable
CDB-S Head Type Dial
Inspection Dial Indicating

• Interchangeable head version of DB


Interchangeable Direct Reading Memory Pointer RoHS

Direction Indicating Torque


• Ideal for torque measuring and quality inspections
Wrench Accuracy ±3%
Tohnichi Torque Range Torque Range Torque RangeOverall
Metric American Weight
Head S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft]
Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
CDB7N4×8D-S 0.7-7 0.1 70CDB4-S 7-70 1 70CDB4-A-S 6-60 1
8D 215 0.45
CDB14N4×8D-S CDB14N4×8D-S 2-14 0.2 140CDB4-S 20-140 2 140CDB4-A-S 20-120 2
10D CDB25N×10D-S 3-25 250CDB-S 30-250 250CDB-A-S 30-220 255 0.48
0.5 5 5
12D CDB50N×12D-S 5-50 500CDB-S 50-500 500CDB-A-S 40-430 330 0.53
lbf·ft lbf·ft
15D CDB100N×15D-S 10-100 1 1000CDB-S 100-1000 10 1000CDB-A-S 7-70 1 415 0.76
19D CDB200N×19D-S 20-200 2 2000CDB-S 200-2000 20 2000CDB-A-S 14-140 2 525 1.0
kgf·m kgf·m
CDB100N×15D-S CDB300N×22D-S 30-300 3000CDB-S 3-30 3000CDB-A-S 20-220 720 1.65
22D 5 0.5 5
CDB420N×22D-S 40-420 4200CDB-S 4-42 4200CDB-A-S 30-300 920 2.7

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. PH (Pipe wrench head) type interchangeable head is not available.
3. Interchangeable heads are optional.

European Style
SCDB-S Interchangeable
Inspection Dial Indicating

• Specialized version of DB
Interchangeable Direct Reading Memory Pointer RoHS

Direction Head Type


• Accepts DIN interchangeable head connection
Dial Indicating
Accuracy ±3%

Torque Wrench for


Quality Inspection
Torque Wrench Torque Range Overall
[N·m] Head Size Weight
S.I. Model Length
Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
SCDB25N-9×12-S 3-25 9×12 271 0.48
0.5
SCDB50N-9×12-S 5-50 9×12 342 0.53
SCDB100N-9×12-S 10-100 1 9×12 422 0.76
SCDB200N-14×18-S 20-200 2 14×18 535 1

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. Applicable to European style head. Tohnichi s interchangeable heads are not available for SCDB-S.
SCDB50N-S

T-Handle Dial Indicating


T-S Torque Wrench
Inspection Dial Indicating

• Dual handle for increased stability


Direct Reading Memory Pointer RoHS

Direction • Memory pointer for easy reading


Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Neck Square
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Length Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
T23N-S 3-23 230T-S 30-230 T200I-3AS 20-200 2 205 71 0.41
0.5 5 9.5
T45N-S 5-45 450T-S 50-450 T400I-3AS 50-400 5 261 82 0.53
lbf·ft lbf·ft
T90N-S 10-90 1 900T-S 100-900 10 T65F-4AS 10-65 1 376 102.5 0.8
12.7
T180N-S 20-180 2 1800T-S 200-1800 20 T130F-4AS 20-130 2 656 118.5 1.2
kgf·m kgf·m
T90N-S
T700N-S 70-700 7000T-S 7-70 7000T-A-S 50-500 1300 19.0 4
10 1 5
T1000N-S 100-1000 10000T-S 10-100 10000T-A-S 50-700 1630 4.8
T1400N-S 200-1400 14000T-S 20-140 14000T-A-S 100-1000 10 1880 25.4 6.2
20 2
T2100N-S 200-2100 21000T-S 20-210 21000T-A-S 200-1500 2500 10
20
T2800N-S 300-2800 28000T-S 30-280 28000T-A-S 200-2000 2960 15.5
50 5 38.1
T4200N-S 400-4200 42000T-S 40-420 42000T-A-S 400-3000 50 3660 21.5

Note 1. T700N-S to T4200N-S models are supplied upon request.


2. For models having over 25.4mm square drive, use with a through-hole socket.

39
Beam Type Inspection Beam Direct Reading RoHS
SF/F/FR Torque
Wrench
• Direct reading torque wrench with scale plate
• For measuring and tightening applications Accuracy ±3%
Direction Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
[cN·m/N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
cN·m cN·m kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
SF40CN 8-40 4SF 0.8-4 4SF-A 0-3.4 115 0.04
2 0.2 0.2
SF70CN 10-70 7SF 1-7 7SF-A 0-6 135 0.05
N·m N·m
SF1.5N 0.2-1.5 0.05 15SF 2-15 0.5 15SF-A 0-13 0.5 145 6.35 0.07
SF6N SF3N 0.5-3 0.1 30SF 5-30 1 30SF-A 0-26 1 175 0.09
SF6N 0.6-6 0.2 60SF 6-60 2 60SF-A 0-50 2 205 0.2
SF12N 2-12 120SF 20-120 120SF-A 0-100 235 0.25
0.5 5 5
F23N 3-23 230F 30-230 230F-A 0-200 295 0.4
9.5
F46N 5-46 1 460F 50-460 10 460F-A 0-400 10 355 0.6
lbf·ft lbf·ft
F92N 10-92 920F 100-920 920F-A 10-66 400 0.95
2 20 2
F130N 20-130 1300F 200-1300 1300F-A 10-95 445 12.7 1.2
F190N 30-190 1900F 300-1900 50 1900F-A 25-135 490 1.5
F92N 5 kgf·m kgf·m
5
F280N 50-280 2800F 5-28 0.5 2800F-A 30-200 565 2.2
F420N 70-420 4200F 7-42 4200F-A 30-300 825 19.0 3.5
F560N 100-560 10 5600F 10-56 1 5600F-A 50-400 945 4.0
10
F700N 100-700 7000F 10-70 7000F-A 50-500 1175 6.0
F850N 100-850 8500F 10-85 8500F-A 60-600 1410 7.8
F1000N 100-1000 10000F 10-100 10000F-A 70-700 1640 8.8
20 2 20
FR1050N 100-1050 10500FR 10-105 10500FR-A 100-750 835 25.4 8
FR1400N 200-1400 14000FR 20-140 14000FR-A 100-1000 981 11.5
FR2100N 300-2100 21000FR 30-210 21000FR-A 200-1500 1148 14.5
50 5
FR2800N 300-2800 28000FR 30-280 28000FR-A 200-2000 1292 20
50
FR4200N 400-4200 42000FR 40-420 42000FR-A 300-3000 1460 38.1 28
100 10
FR6000N 600-6000 60000FR 60-600 60000FR-A 400-4300 1624 30
Torque Wrench for
Quality Inspection

Note 1. FR models are supplied upon request.


2. FR models require winch or mechanical loading device.
3. For models having over 25.4mm square drive, use with a through-hole socket.
4. Accuracy of American models is warranted from 20% of max. torque.

Interchangeable
CSF/CF Head Type Beam
Inspection Beam
• Interchangeable head version of SF/F
Interchangeable Direct Reading RoHS

Direction Type Torque • For measuring and tightening applications Accuracy ±3%
Wrench Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Tohnichi Overall
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
Head S.I. Model Length
Model Model
Size Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [kg]
N·m N·m kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
CSF7N×8D 1-7 0.2 70CSF 10-70 2 70CSF-A 10-60 2 220 0.2
8D
CSF14N×8D 2-14 0.5 140CSF 20-140 5 140CSF-A 20-120 5 250 0.25
10D CF25N×10D 5-25 1 250CF 50-250 10 250CF-A 40-220 10 320 0.4
12D CF50N×12D 10-50 500CF 100-500 500CF-A 80-420 20 380 0.6
CSF7N×8D 2 20 lbf·ft lbf·ft
15D CF100N×15D 10-100 1000CF 100-1000 1000CF-A 6-70 2 435 1.0
19D CF150N×19D 20-150 1500CF 200-1500 50 1500CF-A 15-110 480 1.3
5 kgf·m kgf·m
5
CF230N×22D 30-230 2300CF 3-23 0.5 2300CF-A 20-160 530 1.6
22D
CF420N×22D 70-420 10 4200CF 7-42 1 4200CF-A 30-300 725 3.1
CF25N×10D 32D CF850N×32D 100-850 20 8500CF 42-85 2 8500CF-A 60-600 20 1260 7.1

Note 1. Overall length does not include interchangeable head.


2. PH (Pipe wrench head) type interchangeable head is not available.
3. Interchangeable heads are optional.

Ratchet Head
QF/QFR Beam Type
Inspection Beam
• Fixed ratchet head flat beam style
Ratchet Head Direct Reading RoHS

Direction Torque Wrench • Ideal for working in narrow spaces Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Overall Square
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm/kgf·m] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
QF60N 6-60 1 600QF 60-600 10 600QF-A 0-520 10 455 9.5 0.8
lbf·ft lbf·ft
QF120N 10-120 2 1200QF 100-1200 20 1200QF-A 6-86 2 515 1.2
12.7
QF220N 30-220 5 2200QF 300-2200 50 2200QF-A 25-160 580 1.8
kgf·m kgf·m
QF120N 5
QF320N 40-320 3200QF 6-32 3200QF-A 40-230 655 2.6
QF420N 70-420 4200QF 7-42 4200QF-A 30-300 825 3.4
10 1 19.0
QF560N 100-560 5600QF 10-56 5600QF-A 50-400 950 4.3
10
QF700N 100-700 7000QF 10-70 7000QF-A 50-500 1170 6.5
QF850N 100-850 8500QF 10-85 8500QF-A 60-600 1400 8.5
QFR1050N 100-1050 20 10500QFR 10-105 2 10500QFR-A 100-750 20 845 8.5
25.4
QFR1400N 200-1400 14000QFR 20-140 14000QFR-A 100-1000 992 12.5
QFR2100N 300-2100 21000QFR 30-210 21000QFR-A 200-1500 1158 15.5
50 5
QFR2800N 300-2800 28000QFR 30-280 28000QFR-A 200-2000 1305 21
50
QFR4200N 400-4200 42000QFR 40-420 42000QFR-A 300-3000 1473 38.1 30
100 10
QFR6000N 600-6000 60000QFR 60-600 60000QFR-A 400-4300 1624 32

Note 1. QFR models are supplied upon request.


2. QFR models require winch or mechanical loading device.
3. For models having over 25.4mm square drive, use with a through-hole socket.

40
Interchangeable Socket RoHS

SOCKET FOR HAND TOOL


From Torque Tool SOCKET FOR HAND TOOL
Inlet Drive (Female) 6.35 9.5 12.7 19.0
Width Across Flats (B) 2H 3H 4H 6H
8 201
10 202 210
12 203 211
13 204 212
14 213 220 Inlet Drive (Female) a
16 216 227 Width across flats B
17 214 221
18 217 228 SOCKET
19 215 222 How to Order (Hand Tools)
SOCKET
From Bolt

21 229 237
22 223 230 Indicate model name and Part #
24 224 231
27 225 232 [Ex.] SOCKET 2H-10 202
30 226 233 Socket InIet sign Part #
32 234 Purpose sign Width across flats
34 236 ADAPTER
36 235
41
Indicate model name and Part #
46 [Ex.] ADAPTER 2H-3 270
50 Part #
Inlet Sign (Female)
55
Purpose sign InIet sign (Male)
ADAPTER FOR HAND TOOL
From Torque Tool
Inlet Drive (Female) 6.35 9.5 12.7 19.0 ADAPTER FOR HAND TOOL
Inlet Drive (Male) 2H 3H 4H 6H

Torque Wrench for


Quality Inspection
6.3 (2) 271
To Socket

9.5 (3) 270 273


12.7 (4) 277 272 275
19 (6) 274 ADAPTER
Inlet Drive (Male) a2 Inlet Drive (Female) a1
25.4 (8) 276

SOCKET FOR PNEUMATIC TOOL SOCKET FOR PNEUMATIC TOOL


From Torque Tool
Inlet Drive (Female) 9.5 12.7 25.4
Width Across Flats (B) 3P 4P 8P
10 250
12 251 Width across flats B Inlet Drive (Female) a
13 252
14 253 260
16 255 264 How to Order (Air Tools)
17 254 261 SOCKET
18 265 Indicate model name and Part #
From Bolt

19 262
21 266
[Ex.] SOCKET 3P-10 250
22 263 Socket InIet sign Part #
32 303 Purpose sign Width across flats
34 304 ADAPTER
36 305
Indicate model name and Part #
41 306
46 307 [Ex.] ADAPTER 3P-4 290
50 308 SOCKET Part #
Inlet Sign (Female)
55 309
Purpose sign InIet sign (Male)

ADAPTER FOR PNEUMATIC TOOL


Note O-ring and pin are included.
From Torque Tool
Inlet Drive (Female) 9.5 12.7 19.0 25.4
Inlet Drive (Male) 3P 4P 6P 8P
9.5 (3) 291 ADAPTER FOR PNEUMATIC TOOL
To Socket

12.7 (4) 290 293


19 (6) 292 295
25.4 (8) 294 ADAPTER

Inlet Drive (Male) a Inlet Drive (Female) a1

SOCKET FOR POWER AND HAND TOOL


From Torque Tool
SOCKET FOR HEX HEAD CAP SCREWS
Inlet Drive (Female) 6.35 9.5 12.7 19.0
Width Across Flats (B) 2C 3C 4C 6C
2.5 430
3 431 440
4 432 441
5 442
From Bolt

6 443 450
Width across flats B Inlet Drive (Female) a
8 451
10 452
12 453
14 454 460
17 461 1. O-ring and pin are included.
Note
19 462 2. 430, 431, 432 are not through hole type.

41
Interchangeable Head
SH Open Spanner Head
RoHS

Width
C
1
The SH type spanner heads suit for the place where sockets can not be used, for
flare nuts in piping and for work in narrow places.

t
Tohnichi Model Allowable Torque Outside Width Thickness SH15D×19
Head Size (Body Size × Width) [N·m] [kgf·cm] C [mm] t [mm]
SH8D×5.5 1.5 15 13 3 Tohnichi Model Allowable Torque Outside Width Thickness
SH8D×6 2.5 25 15 3.5 Head Size (Body Size × Width) [N·m] [kgf·cm] C [mm] t [mm]
SH8D×7 3.5 35 17 4 SH15D×24
SH8D×8 7 70 20 4.5 SH15D×26
SH8D×10 14 140 25 SH15D×27
15D 140 1400 60 12
SH8D×11 27 SH15D×30
SH8D×12 5.5
SH15D×32
8D SH8D×13 29 SH15D×36 68
SH8D×14 SH19D×17
SH8D×16 31 SH19D×18 200 2000
15 150
SH8D×17 32 SH19D×19 54 13
SH8D×19 35 6.5 SH19D×21
SH8D×21 36 SH19D×22 180 1800
SH8D×22 37 SH19D×24
SH8D×24 38 19D 200 2000
SH19D×27 60 15
SH10D×7 SH19D×30 180 1800
SH10D×8 SH19D×32
20 200 28
SH10D×10 SH19D×34 200 2000
76 11
SH10D×11 SH19D×36
SH10D×12 SH19D×41 180 1800
SH10D×13 32 SH22D×19
SH10D×14 SH22D×22 280 2800 63
10D SH10D×16 6.5 SH22D×24 500 5000
SH10D×17 SH22D×27
25 250 78
SH10D×18 SH22D×30 420 4200
39
SH10D×19 SH22D×32
22D 15
SH10D×21 SH22D×34 500 5000
SH10D×22 SH22D×36 420 4200
SH10D×24 43 SH22D×41 85
SH22D×46 280 2800
SH12D×8 7 70 20
SH12D×10 12 120 24 5 SH22D×50 103
SH12D×11 20.5 205 28 5.5 SH22D×55 500 5000 108
SH12D×12 31 SH27D×22 255 2550 65 14
SH12D×13 29.5 295 32 6.5 SH27D×24 350 3500 72 15
SH12D×14 38 8 SH27D×27 490 4900 82 16
SH12D×16 59 590 SH27D×30 670 6700 88 19
Accessories

12D SH12D×17 40 10 SH27D×32 750 7500 92


SH12D×18 27D 20
SH27D×34 670 6700 90
SH12D×19 41 11 SH27D×36 94 21
SH12D×21 70 700
SH27D×41 98 22
SH12D×22 43 750 7500
SH27D×46 100 24
SH12D×24 48 13 SH27D×50 103 26
SH12D×27 52 SH32D×27
SH15D×12 SH32D×30
850 8500 105 18
SH15D×13 59 590 38 8 SH32D×32
SH15D×14 SH32D×34
SH15D×16 SH32D×36
15D SH15D×17 32D
SH32D×41 110 24
SH15D×18 SH32D×46
140 1400 51 13 1200 12000
SH15D×19 SH32D×50
SH15D×21 SH32D×55 120 29
SH15D×22 SH32D×60

Inch Size Models


Commonly used in the airline industry and for specific American product installation and maintenance.
Tohnichi Model Inner Width Allowable Torque Outside Width C Thickness t Tohnichi Model Inner Width Allowable Torque Outside Width C Thickness t
Head Size (Body Size × Inner Width [in]) [mm] N·m [lbf·in] mm [in] mm [in] Head Size (Body Size × Inner Width [in]) [mm] N·m [lbf·in] mm [in] mm [in]
SH8D×1/4 6.35 2.5 [22] 15 [0.59] 3.5 [0.14] SH15D×1-1/8 28.58
SH8D×5/16 7.94 7 [61] 20 [0.79] 4.5 [0.18] SH15D×1-3/16 30.16 60 [2.36]
SH8D×3/8 9.53 14 [123] 25 [0.98] SH15D×1-1/4 31.75
8D SH8D×7/16 11.11 27 [1.06] 5.5 [0.22] 15D SH15D×1-5/16 33.34 140 [1239] 12 [0.47]
66 [2.59]
SH8D×1/2 12.7 15 [132] SH15D×1-3/8 34.93
29 [1.14]
SH8D×9/16 14.29 6.5 [0.26] SH15D×1-7/16 36.51
69 [2.72]
SH10D×1/4 6.35 SH15D×1-1/2 38.10
SH10D×5/16 7.94 20 [177] 28 [1.10] SH19D×15/16 23.81
SH10D×3/8 9.53 SH19D×1 25.4 60 [2.36] 15 [0.59]
10D 6.5 [0.26]
SH10D×7/16 11.11 SH19D×1-1/16 26.99
32 [1.26]
SH10D×1/2 12.7 25 [221] SH19D×1-1/8 28.58
SH10D×9/16 14.29 39 [1.54] SH19D×1-3/16 30.16 72 [2.83]
19D 200 [1947]
SH12D×3/8 9.53 12 [106] 24 [0.94] 5 [0.20] SH19D×1-1/4 31.75
SH12D×7/16 11.11 20.5 [181] 31 [1.22] SH19D×1-5/16 33.34 11 [0.43]
6.5 [0.26]
SH12D×1/2 12.7 29.5 [261] 32 [1.26] SH19D×1-3/8 34.93
12D 76 [2.99]
SH12D×9/16 14.29 SH19D×1-7/16 36.51
59 [522] 40 [1.57] 10 [0.39]
SH12D×5/8 15.88 SH19D×1-1/2 38.1
SH12D×11/16 17.46 70 [620] 41 [1.61] 11 [0.43]
SH15D×1/2 12.7 38 [1.50] 8 [0.31]
SH15D×9/16 14.29 59 [522]
SH15D×5/8 15.88
SH15D×11/16 17.46
51 [2.01] 13 [0.51]
SH15D×3/4 19.05
15D
SH15D×13/16 20.64
140 [1239]
SH15D×7/8 22.23
SH15D×15/16 23.81
SH15D×1 25.40 60 [2.36] 12 [0.47]
SH15D×1-1/16 26.99

42
The Relationship between Interchangeable Heads and Torque Wrenches


Nominal diameter
Tohnichi’s interchangeable head wrenches have specific diameter round


ends that fit into corresponding head base openings. Head and wrench CL100N×15D
model names include the diameter sizes so heads can be matched to
wrenches that will accept those heads.


For example: SH15D×17 will fit on CL100N×15D Nominal diameter
A variety of different head types (SH, RH, QH, RQH, FH, DH, AH and SH-N) 15D=φ15


can be used on one wrench or different types of wrenches such as CL (for
tightening) and CEM3 (for inspection) can use the same head that has the SH15D×17
corresponding diameter size.

RH Ring Head

Width
C
RoHS
1

The RH type ring heads guarantee the safe work as the axes of bolt and RH ring
head are always aligned and prevent the heads will drop.

t
RH15D×17
Note: RH8D×5.5 to RH8D×7 are hex shape.

Tohnichi Model Allowable Torque Outside Width Thickness Tohnichi Model Allowable Torque Outside Width Thickness
Head Size (Body Size × Width) [N·m] [kgf·cm] C [mm] t [mm] Head Size (Body Size × Width) [N·m] [kgf·cm] C [mm] t [mm]
RH8D×5.5 1.5 15 10.5 RH19D×14 59 590 22.5 8
5
RH8D×6 2.4 24 11 RH19D×17 27 10
100 1000
RH8D×7 3.6 36 12 RH19D×18 28 11
6
RH8D×8 7.2 72 13.5 RH19D×19 29
8D 166 1660
RH8D×10 12.2 122 15.5 RH19D×21
32 13
RH8D×11 17 RH19D×22
7
RH8D×12 15 140 18 19D RH19D×24 35
RH8D×13 19 RH19D×27 39
RH10D×8 7.2 72 12.5 6 RH19D×30 41
200 2000
RH10D×10 12.2 122 15.5 7 RH19D×32 44 15
RH10D×11 20 200 17 RH19D×34 47
RH10D×12 18 RH19D×36 49
RH10D×13 19 RH19D×41 55
RH10D×14 20 RH22D×19 166 1660 30
10D 14
RH10D×16 22 RH22D×22 34
8 255 2550
RH10D×17 25 250 24 RH22D×24 37 15
RH10D×18 25 RH22D×27 490 4900 41
RH10D×19 26 RH22D×30 44
22D
RH10D×21 28 RH22D×32 45
RH10D×22 29 RH22D×34 49 17
500 5000

Accessories
RH12D×8 7.2 72 15 RH22D×36 51
5
RH12D×10 12.2 122 16 RH22D×41 57
RH12D×11 20 200 18 5.5 RH22D×46 62
RH12D×12 20 RH27D×22 255 2550 14
29.5 295 6.5 38
RH12D×13 21 RH27D×24 350 3500 15
RH12D×14 20 RH27D×27 490 4900 42 16
12D 59 590 10
RH12D×16 24 RH27D×30 670 6700 46 19
RH12D×17 25 RH27D×32 750 7500 48
27D 20
RH12D×18 12 RH27D×34 670 6700 51
26
RH12D×19 70 700 RH27D×36 52 21
RH12D×21 29 RH27D×41 58 22
13 750 7500
RH12D×22 30 RH27D×46 64 24
RH15D×12 RH27D×50 69 26
29.5 295 19 7
RH15D×13 RH32D×27 490 4900 43 16
RH15D×14 22 RH32D×30 670 6700 46.5
59 590 8
RH15D×16 25 RH32D×32 49 18
860 8600
RH15D×17 RH32D×34 52
100 1000 26 10
RH15D×18 RH32D×36 53
15D 32D
RH15D×19 28 RH32D×41 59 24
RH15D×21 RH32D×46 65
31 1200 12000
RH15D×22 RH32D×50 69 27
140 1400 13
RH15D×24 34 RH32D×55 75
29
RH15D×27 37 RH32D×60 80
RH15D×30 41

Inch Size Models


Commonly used in the airline industry and for specific American product installation and maintenance.
Tohnichi Model Inner Width Allowable Torque Outside Width C Thickness t Tohnichi Model Inner Width Allowable Torque Outside Width C Thickness t
Head Size (Body Size × Inner Width [in]) [mm] N·m [lbf·in] mm [in] mm [in] Head Size (Body Size × Inner Width [in]) [mm] N·m [lbf·in] mm [in] mm [in]
RH8D×1/4 6.35 3.6 [31] 11 [0.43] 5 [0.20] RH15D×1/2 12.7 29.5 [261] 19 [0.81] 7 [0.28]
RH8D×5/16 7.94 7.2 [63] 13.5 [0.53] 6 [0.24] RH15D×9/16 14.29 22 [0.87]
8D 59 [522] 8 [0.31]
RH8D×3/8 9.53 12.2 [108] 15 [0.59] 15D RH15D×5/8 15.88 25 [0.98]
7 [0.28]
RH8D×7/16 11.11 15 [132] 17 [0.67] RH15D×11/16 17.46 100 [885] 26 [1.06] 10 [0.39]
RH10D×1/4 6.35 11 [0.43] RH15D×3/4 19.05 140 [1239] 28 [1.10] 13 [0.51]
7.2 [64] 6 [0.24]
RH10D×5/16 7.94 12.5 [0.49]
RH10D×3/8 9.53 12.2 [108] 15.5 [0.61] 7 [0.28]
10D
RH10D×7/16 11.11 17 [0.67]
RH10D×1/2 12.7 25 [221] 19 [0.75] 8 [0.31]
RH10D×9/16 14.29 20 [0.79]
RH12D×3/8 9.53 12.2 [108] 16 [0.63] 5 [0.20]
RH12D×7/16 11.11 20 [177] 18 [0.71] 5.5 [0.22]
12D RH12D×1/2 12.7 29.5 [261] 21 [0.83] 6.5 [0.26]
RH12D×9/16 14.29 20 [0.79]
59 [522] 10 [0.39]
RH12D×5/8 15.88 24 [0.94]

43
The Relationship between Interchangeable Heads and Torque Wrenches


Nominal diameter
Tohnichi’s interchangeable head wrenches have specific diameter round


ends that fit into corresponding head base openings. Head and wrench CL100N×15D
model names include the diameter sizes so heads can be matched to


wrenches that will accept those heads. Nominal diameter
15D=φ15
For example: SH15D×17 will fit on CL100N×15D


A variety of different head types (SH, RH, QH, RQH, FH, DH, AH and SH-N)
can be used on one wrench or different types of wrenches such as CL (for SH15D×17
tightening) and CEM3 (for inspection) can use the same head that has the
corresponding diameter size.

QH Ratchet Head RoHS DH Square Drive Head RoHS

C
C
C

1
ℓ1
1
ℓ1
h
h

h
h
QH15D
b
b

b
b
DH15D
a
□a

As the QH type ratchet heads need only small swing for tightening, they suit for The DH square drive heads are the standard interchangeable head. They are useful
operations in narrow spaces. when tightening a large number of matching screws with a common torque wrench.
Dimensions It is recommended to keep one set. They are used with sockets.
Tohnichi
Model Sq. Drive Outside Width h b Dimensions
Head Size Tohnichi
a [mm] c [mm] [mm] [mm] Model Sq. Drive Outside Width h b
Head Size
8D QH8D 23 17.5 a [mm] c [mm] [mm] [mm]
6.35 7.5
QH10D-1/4 18.5 10D DH10D 22.5
10D 26 9.53 18 13
QH10D 22 12D DH12D 23
12D QH12D 9.53 32 25.6 11 15D DH15D 22
12.7 29.5 16.5
QH15D-3/8 30.5 19D DH19D 24
15D 37.5
QH15D 33.5 14 22D DH22D 34 43.3
19.05 23.5
19D QH19D 12.7 40 38.4 15.4 27D DH27D 42 44.5
QH22D-1/2 41.5 15.5 32D DH32D 25.4 50 58.5 30.25
22D 51
QH22D 46.5 20.5
19.05 Note DH32D is a through hole type.
27D QH27D 70 49.7 21.5
32D QH32D 25.4 74 55.7 26.5

Note 1. For the model having 25.4mm square drive, use a through-hole socket.
QH15D-3/8 Tmax 100N·m
QH22D-1/2 Tmax 280N·m
2. Ratchet protective cover is available. Refer to page 46.
HH Фd2
φd2
Hex Head RoHS
m
m
Accessories

W
w
c
C

RQH Female Ratchet Head RoHS ℓ1


HH10D×6

HH hex-head is for
hexagon socket
C
W

tt

head bolts. A hex


key can be inserted.
ℓ1 Hex key (Sold separately)

The HH hex-head is for hex. socket head cap screws.


RQH15D×17 Dimensions
H

Tohnichi Model
Outside Width t m φd2
h

Head Size (Body Size × Width)


φ
ФDD C [mm] [mm] [mm] b [mm]
8D HH8D 12 14.5 - -
As the RQH type ratchet heads need only small swing for tightening, they suit for HH10D×5 11
operations in narrow and low ceiling spaces. 10D HH10D×6 12 8
Dimensions HH10D×8 15
Tohnichi Model HH12D×5 11 19 7
D Outside Width H h
Head Size (Body Size × Width)
[mm] C [mm] [mm] [mm] HH12D×6 14
12D 10
RQH12D×12 HH12D×8 15
12D 20.5 32 24.1
RQH12D×14 HH12D×10 17
RQH15D×14 HH15D×8 14
15D 24.5 37.5 29
RQH15D×17 HH15D×10 17
15D 21
RQH19D×17 10 HH15D×12 20
19D RQH19D×19 31 45 28 HH15D×14 21.5
RQH19D×22 HH19D×10 17 13 8.5
RQH22D×22 HH19D×12 21.5
22D 35.2 51 35
RQH22D×24 19D HH19D×14 23 23
HH19D×17 27
HH19D×19 29
HH22D×12 19.5
HH22D×14 27
Ratchet Protective Cover for QH/RQH 22D HH22D×17 30 17 26 10
HH22D×19 32
Fit on your Tohnichi Ratchet Head to protect your work
HH22D×22 35
Part # Applicable Interchangeable Head
Note 1. To be used with hex. key inserted.
870 QH8D
2. HH8D is not used with hex. key but interchangeable bit.
871 QH10D 3. Insertion of HH10D×5 and HH10D×6 are hexagon. Others are
872 QH12D/RQH12D double hexagon.
872 with QH12D 874 QH15D/RQH15D
875 QH19D
876 RQH19D
HH8D
878 QH22D/RQH22D
Bits are sold separately.
Refer to page 11.
870

44
AH/AH2 Adjustable Open End Head RoHS SH-N Open End Head with Notch RoHS

SW

11

H
t
h
SH-N models
AH15D2×30 SH10D-1×10N
(except for SH10D-5×10N)

Model
Maximum torque (Tmax)

H
AH is easy and convenient to use for applications that require different size bolt heads.

t
Available currently only for the 15mm diameter root shaped Tohnichi torque wrenches.
SH10D-5×10N
Tohnichi Model Allowable Inner Width Dimensions
Head (Body Size Torque Min.-Standard-Max. S L t h The notch creates speed in the tightening process by grasping the side of the
Size × Width) [N·m] [kgf·cm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] fastener without removing the wrench. Ideal for brake line assembly.
AH10D×13 3-8-13 36 57 9 23
10D 25 250 Tohnichi Dimensions
AH10D×26 7-17-26 49 62 11 25 Model Allowable Torque
Head Outside Width Thickness
AH12D×13 30 300 3-8-13 36 66 9 23 (Body Size × Width)
Size [N·m] [kgf·cm] C [mm] H [mm] t [ mm] h [mm]
12D AH12D×26 7-17-26 49 71 11 26
SH10D-1×10N 18.75 12 6
AH12D×36 50 500 8-22-36 65 78 13 27 22.5 225
SH10D-3×10N 20.25 7.5
AH15D2×26 10-18-26 50 77 11 31 15
SH10D-5×10N 19 190 24.5 -
15D AH15D2×30 100 1000 13-22-30 60 84 12 32 24
10D SH10D-4×10N 17.75 5
AH15D2×36 140 1400 13-24-36 65 87 13 33 10
SH10D-9×10N 22.5 225 18.75
6
Note Use with a click type torque wrench. SH10D×11N 18.8 12
SH10D×12N 25 250 32 16 6.5 3.25
SH12D×11N 30 19 7.5 -
SH12D-1×12N 21 12 6
PH Pipe Wrench Head RoHS SH12D-3×12N
SH12D-5×12N
30 300
32
22.5
26
15
7.5
-
SH12D-4×12N 20 10 5
SH12D-1×14N 21 12 6
12D SH12D-3×14N 22.5 7.5
40 400 35 15
PH15D×350 SH12D-5×14N 26 -
SH12D-4×14N 20 10 5
SH12D-1×17N 21 12 6
The PH heads suit for use with pipes and plumbing applications.
SH12D-3×17N 22.5 7.5
50 500 38 15
Model Pipe Wrench Head Applicable Pipe Standard Pipe SH12D-5×17N 26 -
Tohnichi Recommendable
(Body Size × Max. Length Diameter Diameter SH12D-4×17N 20 10 5

Accessories
Head Size Torque Wrench
Width) [mm] [mm] [mm]
15D PH15D×350
19D PH19D×350 350 13-38 25.5
CSP
PH22D×350
22D

Note
PH22D×450 450 26-52
1. PH can be used with CSP model (P.19) only.
39
Common Dimensions for Interchangeable Head
2. When ordering with CSP, please specify PH model name and
Dimensions [mm]
required set torque. Model
1 2 3 4 d3 d4 W
3. In case of using graduated torque wrench, order PHL models.
SH8D, RH, QH, HH 35 4 10 2 8 3.0 9
SH10D, RH, QH, HH, DH, SH-N 44 5 12 2.5 10 3.5 12
SH12D, RH, QH, HH, DH, RQH 53 6 14 3 12 3.5 14

FH Hook Head RoHS


SH15D, RH, QH, HH, DH, RQH, FH
SH19D, RH, QH, HH, DH, RQH, FH
63
80
7.5
9.5
17
21
3
3
15
19
4.5
4.5
17
21
60
° SH22D, RH QH, HH, DH, RQH, FH 100 11 24 3.5 22 5.5 24
L2 φd
SH27D, RH, QH, DH 125 13.5 29 5 27 6.5 30
SH32D, RH, QH, DH 160 16 34 7 32 6.5 35
r

φD
b

ℓ1

FH
H
t

1
The FH hook heads are ideal for use with bearing locknut applications. 2
Tohnichi Model Applicable Size Dimensions φ d4
Nominal Size
Head (Body Size of Nut Outside r ' b t H D L2 d
of Screw
Size × Width) Diameter [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
FH15D×30 30-38 M20 16
d3

3 6 30
W

FH15D×38 38-45 M25 20


15D FH15D×45 45-52 M30 24 25 7.5
3.5 7 30.5 4.5
FH15D×52 52-58 M35 27 60
FH15D×58 58-65 M40 31 31 3 4
4.5
19D FH19D×65 65-75 M45, M50 35.5 8 35.5 29 9.5
FH22D×75 75-85 M60, M65 39 38.5
22D 5 32 11 5.5
FH22D×85 85-98 M70, M75 45.5 45 10 40 When requesting a special head that is used with various types of
Note
torque wrench, it is strictly required to follow the " 1" dimension to
keep torque accuracy. Any diviation from the " 1"dimension affects
torque accuracy.

45
Auxiliary Equipment
To facilitate effective and convenient use of Tohnichi products, a number of auxiliary parts and special tools are available (Some torque tools
are provided with the necessary auxiliary parts). We are ready to manufacture custom-made parts and tools to meet your requirements.

For Torque Wrench For Torque Screwdriver

QH/QL/PQL/QSP PROTECTIVE HEAD COVER LTD, RTD ADJUSTING TOOL FOR LTD/RTD
Fit on your Tohnichi Ratchet Head to protect your work This tool is used to adjust the torque of LTD and RTD torque screwdrivers.
Part # Applicable Interchangeable Head & Model
Part # Applicable Model
870 QH8D QL·PQL2N-15N/-MH, QSP1.5N4-12N4
51 LTD/RTD15CN, LTD/RTD30CN
871 QH10D QL·PQL·QSP25N/-MH
46 LTD/RTD60CN
872 QH12D/RQH12D QL·PQL·QSP50N/-MH
873 - QL·PQL·QSP100N4/-MH 47 LTD/RTD260CN
874 QH15D/RQH15D QL·PQL·QSP140N/-MH 48 LTD/RTD500CN
875 QH19D QL·PQL·QSP200N4/-MH 49 LTD/RTD1000CN
876 RQH19D - 1046 LTD/RTD120CN
877 - QL·PQL·QSP280N4/-MH
878 QH22D/RQH22D QL·PQL·QSP420N
LTD TIGHTENING TOOL FOR LTD
TiQLE ADJUSTING TOOL FOR TiQLE This tool makes tightening with large LTD much easier.
For previous large QLE and current TiQLE models Part # Applicable Model
LTD/RTD/NTD/RNTD500CN
Part # Applicable Model 31
FTD400CN
301 TiEQLE750N-TiEQLE1400N
LTD/NTD1000CN
32
FTD8N, FTD16N
40 LTD2000CN
SP THRUSTRING TOOL FOR SP
This tool is used to set the torque of preset types SP, RSP, QSP and LTD/RTD/MNTD HOOK SPANNER
CSP torque wrenches. This tool makes it easier to set the torque for mid. to large capacity
Part # Tool # Applicable Model torque screwdrivers.
310 A-1 QSP/CSP1.5N-6N Part # Applicable Model
SP2N-SP19N, QSP/CSP12N,
311 A-2 52 LTD/RTD260CN, MNTD120CN
QSP/CSP25N
53 LTD/RTD500CN, MNTD260CN
312 A-3 SP38N, SP67N, QSP/CSP50N-140N
54 LTD1000CN, MNTD500CN
313 A-4 SP120N-SP310N, QSP200N-QSP280N
314 A-5 QSP/CSP420N, BQSP/BCSP400N 55 LTD2000CN
315 A-6 SP420N, SP560N
NTD/RNTD
Accessories

ADJUSTING BAR FOR NTD/RNTD


QSP3 ADJUSTING TOOLS FOR QSP3 This tool is used to set the torque of preset types NTD and RNTD
Dimensions
screwdrivers.
Part # Applicable Model Part # Applicable Model
[mm]
42 NTD/RNTD15CN-120CN
QSP/CSP25N3, QSP1.5N4-12N4
43 NTD/RNTD260CN, RNTDZ260CN
SP2N2-19N2, SP19N2-N
931 2.5 × 1.5 × 6 44 NTD/RNTD500CN-1000CN, RNTDZ500CN
BQSP/BCSP10N-20N
CSP1.5N4-CSP12N4
QSP/CSP50N3-QSP/CSP280N3 TORQUE SCREWDRIVER ADAPTER
QSP100N4, QSP200N4, SP38N2-N
930 4 × 2.5 × 8
BQSP/BCSP40N-300N This accessory is used with TME2 and TM torque meters to check
SP/RSP38N2-310N2 UNITORK and torque screwdrivers.

DB TOOL SET FOR DB


This set of pliers is used to adjust the torque for dial type torque
Part # Applicable Model
wrenches and torque checkers. LTD/RTD/NTD/RNTD
30
FTD50CN-FTD400CN

Part # Applicable Model


316 DB, DBE, CDB-S, T-S, DOT

Lubricant for repairing torque products EVERTORQUE


CARRYING CASE
Model Part #
EVERTORQUE 830 RoHS

Applicable Models and Parts


842 846 Applicable Model Applicable Part
Part # Dimensions [mm] Weight [kg] QL, QLE2, CL, CLE2, Thrustring; Steel Ball
QL50N/-MH, MTQL40N/70N, QL100N4-MH, CL50N×12D/-MH, PQL, PCL, YCL etc. Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread
842 CL50N×15D/-MH, CL100N×15D-MH 0.25 Thrustring; Steel Ball
H60 × W400 × D70 Click Type Torque WQL Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread
QL140N/-MH, MTQL140N, QL200N4/-MH, CL140N×15D/-MH, Wrench Screw Knob, Protector; Joint
843 CL200N×19D/-MH 0.36 Thrustring; Steel Ball
H60 × W520 × D80 MPQL Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread
QL140N/-MH and below, MTQL and below, CL200N×19D/-MH
Ratchet, Marker Pipe; Joint
846 and below 1.0
Click Type Torque RTD, RNTD Main Shaft, Toggle Sheet; Serration
H170 × W500 × D100
Screwdriver RTD, LTD, BMLD Case, Adjusting Piece; Thread
QL280N/-MH and below, CL280N×22D/-MH and below
847 1.6
H170 × W740 × D100

46
Connecting Cable * The cable length is 2m.

EPP16M3 Printer Connecting Cable


Part # Applicable Model Figure Plug

383 DOTE3-G (P.54), LC3-G (P.56), TDT3-G (P.53), TME2 (P.59), CD5 (P.64) D-SUB 9 Pin Female

CEM3-G/CEM3-P (P.36), CTA2-G (P.24), R-DT999 (P.64),


575 D-SUB 9 Pin Female
CTB2-G (P.37)

PC Connecting Cable
Part # Applicable Model Figure Plug

575 CEM3-G/CEM3-P (P.36), CTA2-G (P.24), R-DT999 (P.64), CTB2-G (P.37) D-SUB 9 Pin Female

584 CEM3-G/CEM3-P (P.36), CTA2-G (P.24), R-DT999 (P.64), CTB2-G (P.37) USB A type

585 CPT-G (P.23) D-SUB 9 Pin Female

383 DOTE3-G (P.54), LC3-G (P.56), TDT3-G (P.53), TME2 (P.59), CD5 (P.64) D-SUB 9 Pin Female

384 STC2-G (P.10), ST3-G (P.56), ATGE-G (P.57), BTGE-G (P.58) USB A type

385 LC3-G (P.56), TDT3-G (P.53) USB A type

Accessories
Quick Charger, Battery Pack, AC Adapter
Quick Charger Battery Pack
Model Applicable Model Figure Model Applicable Model Figure

RoHS CEM3-G/CEM3-P (P.36), CTA2-G (P.24) CEM3-G/CEM3-P (P.36)


BP-5
CTB2-G (P.37) (100-240V) CTA2-G (P.24), CTB2-G (P.37)
BC-3-G

RoHS
ST3-G (P.56) BP-7 STC2-G (P.10)
BC-4-2

RoHS DOTE3-G (P.54), LC3-G (P.56),


TDT3-G (P.53), TME2 (P.59), CD5 (P.64)
BP-100-3

AC Adapter
Model Applicable Model Figure Model Applicable Model Figure

RoHS DOTE3-G (P.54), LC3-G (P.56), RoHS


TME2 (P.59)
TDT3-G (P.53), CD5 (P.64)
BA-6 BA-4

RoHS
ATGE-G (P.57), BTGE-G (P.58) BA-7 STC2-G (P.10)
BA-5

NEW BA-8 R-BT (P.49), R-BLA (P.31), R-BLE (P.31)

47
Semi-Automatic Assembly Angle Pneumatic Graduation Push button RoHS
A/AC2 Airtork
• Pneumatic motor mounted on torque wrench
• After provisional tightening by an air motor at high speed, final tightening is
Direction performed manually.
• A: Low provisional torque type
• AC: High provisional torque type
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Max.Provisional Free Air Hose Overall Square
Metric American Tightening Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Torque Speed Pressure Dia. Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [N·m] [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
lbf·in lbf·in
A10N 3-10 0.1 A100 30-100 1 A100-A 30-90 1
A100N Low provisional type A25N 5-25 0.25 A225 50-250 2.5 A225-A 50-200 2.5 1.8 750 278 9.5 1.0
A50N 10-50 0.5 A450 100-500 5 A450-A 100-400 5
lbf·ft lbf·ft
φ5
A100N 20-100 1 A900 200-1000 10 A900-A 15-65 1 2.5 340 1.43
800 12.7
A180N 40-180 2 A1800 400-1800 20 A1800-A 30-130 2 5 489 2.6
lbf·in lbf·in 0.6
A180N Low provisional type AC25N2 5-25 0.25 AC250M2 50-250 2.5 AC200I2-3/8 50-200 2.5 1.0
11 1000 293
AC50N2 10-50 0.5 AC500M2 100-500 5 AC400I2-3/8 100-400 5 1.5
9.5
- - - - - - AC800I2-3/8 200-800 10
lbf·ft lbf·ft
17.5 900 334 2.0
- - - - - - AC75F2-3/8 15-75 1 φ6
AC100N2 20-100 1 AC1000M2 200-1000 10 - - -
12.7
AC180N 40-180 2 A1800C 400-1800 20 AC130F-4A 30-130 2 19 800 489 3.3
Note 1. Rated voltage of the limit switch is AC/DC 30V, below 1A.
2. Use pneumatic sockets only.
3. S.Q. Drive Through Hole

AC50N2 High provisional type ALS/ACLS2


• A/AC style with limit switch output
• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Torque Range Max.Provisional Free Air Hose Overall Square
Metric Tightening Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] Torque Speed Pressure Dia. Length Drive
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [N·m] [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
ALS10N 3-10 0.1 A100LS 30-100 1
1.2
ALS25N 5-25 0.25 A225LS 50-225 2.5 1.8 750 278
ALS50N 10-50 0.5 A450LS 100-500 5 φ5 9.5 1.7
ACLS100N2 High provisional with limit switch type
ACLS25N2 5-25 0.25 ACLS250M2 50-250 2.5 0.6 1.2
11 1000 293
ACLS50N2 10-50 0.5 ACLS500M2 100-500 5 1.7
ACLS100N2 20-100 1 ACLS1000M2 200-1000 10 17.5 900 334 2.2
φ6 12.7
ACLS180N 40-180 2 A1800CLS 400-1800 20 19 800 489 3.5

UNITORK/Pistol Type
AUR Pneumatic Torque
Screwdriver
Assembly Pistol

• High speed and high accuracy tightening


Pneumatic Graduation Trigger RoHS

Direction • Easy torque adjustment by scale with key


Power Torque Tools

Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Free Air Hose in Standard
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Speed Pressure Dia. Accessory
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] Bit + [kg]
AUR5N 2-5 0.1 AU50R 20-50 1 AU50R-A 15-45 1 2100 #3 1.5
AUR12.5N 5-12.5 0.25 AU125R 50-125 2.5 AU125R-A 37.5-112.5 2.5 800 0.5 φ10 -
1.7
AUR25N 10-25 0.5 AU250R 100-250 5 AU250R-A 75-225 5 400 -
Note 1. AUR5N has #3 bit, 6.35 HEX, with a double bit. Any other bits are available in the local market.
2. AUR12.5N and AUR25N have a fixed 9.53mm square drive. Use pneumatic sockets only.
Standard Accessories 1. Torque adjusting key
2. Supportive Handle for AUR25N/AURLS25N
3. W12 Open ended spanner for AUR25N/AURLS25N

AURLS
• AUR style with limit switch output
• Wired Error-Proofing, Pokayoke, system for assembly processes
Accuracy ±5%
AUR12.5N
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Free Air Hose in Standard
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Speed Pressure Dia. Accessory
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] Bit + [kg]
AURLS5N 2-5 0.1 AU50RLS 20-50 1 AU50RLS-A 15-45 1 2100 #3 1.5
AURLS12.5N 5-12.5 0.25 AU125RLS 50-125 2.5 AU125RLS-A 37.5-112.5 2.5 800 0.5 φ10 -
1.7
AURLS25N 10-25 0.5 AU250RLS 100-250 5 AU250RLS-A 75-225 5 400 -

POKA Patrol, Count Checker


CNA-4mk3
Refer to page 28.

* Sold Separately

48
Battery Operated Assembly Angle Electric Re-Chargeable Graduation Push button
HAC Semi-Automatic
Torque Wrench • More reasonable and accurate than electric hand nutrunner
• Provisional tightening by electric motor and final tightening by hand. Two in one
Direction function.
NEW
• Pokayoke function is equipped as standard.
• Capable of calibrating by torque wrench tester
Accuracy ±3%
Torque Range Max. Provisional
[N·m] Free Speed Overall Length Square Drive Weight
S.I. Model Tightening
Min.-Max. Grad. torque [r.p.m] [mm] [mm] [kg]
NEW HA25N 4 1000 406 1.5
5~25 0.25
HAC50N NEW HAC25N 9.53
11 1100 445 1.9
NEW HAC50N 10~50 0.5
NEW HAC100N 20~100 491 2.4
1 17.5 1000
Battery Reference NEW HAC140N 30~140 557 12.7 2.8
For battery and charger, HItachi Koki NEW HAC200N 40~200 2 30 580 670 3.6
UC18 series are available commercially. Note 1. Provisional torque is easily changed in 3 levels.
2. Battery charger, Battery, Balancer, Receiver/R-BT, and Adapter/BA-8 are optional.
3. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country.
Standard Accessories Hex bit W=4/Adjusting tool

Bluetooth® Receiver
Model Version
Battery Charger BC18YSL3 R-BT V3.0
Note 1. It is receivable up to 4 pcs of HAC.
2. Supplied with DC24V input
terminal
3. Communication distance is
approx. 10m.

HAC with balancer R-BT R-BT AC Adapter


Battery BP1825 BP1850 Balancer Model
BA-8
Model Applicable model
343 HAC25N, 50N Note AC100-240V is applicable.
Note 1. Guideline tightening No. is 1500 344 HAC100N, 140N, 200N
operations for BP1825 and 3000
operation for BP1850.
2. The guideline is in case of middle
joint. It is subject to change due
to joint coefficient.

BA-8

HANDYTORK/
HAT Battery Operated
Torque Screwdriver
Assembly Pistol Re-Chargeable

• Easy calibration check with standard torque wrench tester


Graduation Trigger

Direction • Available with reverse and as FH version


Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range
[N·m] Free Speed Voltage Square Drive Weight

Power Torque Tools


S.I. Model
HAT HATR Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m.] DC [V] [mm] [kg]
HAT25N 700
10-25 0.5 12 9.5 1.8
HATR25N 140
Note 1. Torque accuracy is based upon static torque measured by torque wrench tester.
2. HATR/HATRFH has a reverse mode function.
3. HATFH/HATRFH is error-proofing (Pokayoke) type, and it can be used only with R-FH256 receiver (sold
separately) as count verification system.
4. Use pneumatic sockets only.
5. HAT battery and battery charger are optional.
6. It is designed for 100V usage only.
Standard Accessories 1. W4 hex key
2. Supportive handle for HAT25N, HATR25N, HATFH25N, HATRFH25N

HATFH
• Wireless error-proofing, Pokayoke, system for HAT
HAT25N • Tightening completion signal output to eliminate missed tightening
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range
[N·m] Free Speed Voltage Square Drive Weight
S.I. Model
HAT Optional Accessories Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m.] DC [V] [mm] [kg]
HATFH25N 700
10-25 0.5 12 9.5 1.8
HATRFH25N 140

BP-12
Battery Receiver POKA Patrol, Count Checker
Model
BP-12
Description
DC 12V
R-FH256 CNA-4mk3
Refer to page 28 and 30 for Refer to page 28.
Pokayoke system configuration.

BC-1 *Sold separately


Battery Charger
Part # Model * Sold Separately
820 BC-1 (AC100V)

49
Fully-Automatic Electric Assembly Straight Electric Graduation Push button RoHS
DU Torque Screwdriver
• Easy torque set with external scale
• Blushless motor : high durability and low noise
Direction NEW
• Ideal for torque traceability
• Control the number of tightening to eliminate missed tightening
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Free Speed Applicable Screw size Overall
Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m] [r.p.m] (Ref.) Length
Min.-Max. Grad. High Low Standard High-strength [mm] [kg]
cN·m cN·m
NEW DU30CN 10-30 0.5 M2 (M2.2) (M1.8) M2
1500 1050
NEW DU60CN 20-60 1 M2.5, M3 (M2.2) M2.5 281 0.6
DU250CN NEW DU100CN 40-100 2 1400 980 (M3.5) M3 (M3.5)
NEW DU250CN 100-250 5 1200 840 M4 (M4.5) M4 305 0.82
Note 1. Cable and DU-Counter are required and sold separately.
2. TCF is available as a checker. Refer to page 60.
3. Counterclockwise rotation has no torque control. It is loosening purpose only.

DU-COUNTER Specifications
Model DU-COUNTER
Counter Display 2 digits 7 segments
DU-COUNTER Judgement Blue/Red
Number of Tightening 1-99
Judgement Mode Preset, Automatic judgment - 0~99 seconds/per sec.
Output OK/NG output, Relay contact: DC30V 1A, AC125V 0.3A
Input RESET input
Double tightening prevention/1-99 sec.
Timer Function Auto-reset/0-60 sec.
Cable for DU/DU-Counter Interval warning/0-99 sec.
Power Source AC100V-240V±10% 50/60Hz 3.6A MAX
Cable for DU and DU-COUNTER Output Voltage DC36V 13.4A MAX
Dimension W159.2 × D220 × H83
Part # Applicable Model Length [m] Weight[kg] 1.3
516 2 Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40
DU and DU-COUNTER
517 5 Accessories AC cable
Applicable Model DU30/60/100/250CN

UNITORK/Straight &
U/UR Pistol Type Pneumatic
Assembly Straight/Pistol Pneumatic

• Accurate and stable tightening for small size screws


Graduation Trigger/Lever RoHS

Direction Torque Screwdriver


• Lever activated
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Free Air Hose in Standard
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Speed Pressure Dia. Accessory
U UR Min.-Max. Grad.
Model
Min.-Max. Grad.
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] [kg] Bit +
cN·m cN·m kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
U30CN 10-30 0.5 U3 1-3 0.05 U3-A 1-3 0.05 1600 0.4 0.32 #0
Power Torque Tools

U60CN 20-60 1 U6 2-6 0.1 U6-A 2-5 0.1 1700 φ5 0.42 #1


0.5
U120CN 40-120 2 U12 4-12 0.2 U12-A 4-10 0.2 1400 0.48
#2
U250CN 100-250 5 U25 10-25 0.5 U25-A 8-22 0.5 1200 0.6 0.75
U500CN 200-500 U50-2 20-50 U50-2-A 15-45 950 0.5 φ6 1.35
10 1.0 1.0 #3
U1000CN 400-1000 U100 40-100 U100-A 30-90 700 0.6 2.0
ULR120CN 40-120 2 U12LR 4-12 0.2 U12LR-A 4-10 0.2 1300 0.5 φ5 0.56
#2
ULR250CN 100-250 5 U25LR 10-25 0.5 U25LR-A 8-22 0.5 1000 0.95
0.6 φ6
UR500CN 200-500 10 U50R 20-50 1.0 U50R-A 15-45 1.0 950 1.45 #3
U120CN
Note 1. U1000CN has a fixed square drive (9.53mm). Use socket bits or bit holders for this model.
2. U500CN, 1000CN, and UR500CN are pistol type with trigger mechanism.
3. Standard bits available in the local market can be used.
4. Counterclockwise rotation has no torque control and it is loosening purpose only.
Standard Accessories 1. One Touch Joint #130 for U30CN-250CN, ULR120CN, and ULR250CN.
2. Bit holder for U1000CN

U/UR Optional Accessories

One Touch Joint (Female) Torque-fix


Joint to connect UNITORK to air hoses For torque adjustment
Part # Applicable Model Size Part # Applicable Model
130 PF 1/4 Female 145 U30CN-U120CN
131 U30CN-U250CN PF 1/4 Male 146 U250CN
132 φ8 Hose Joint 147 U500CN, UR500CN

Hand Cover Tool Kit


For hand slip protection Tools for disassembly/assembly for UNITORK
Part # Applicable Model Part # Applicable Model
150 U30CN-U120CN 160 U30CN-U250CN
151 U250CN 161 U250CN
162 U500CN, UR500CN
163 U1000CN

50
Fully-Automatic Airtork Assembly Pistol Pneumatic Graduation Trigger/Lever RoHS
AP • For large bolt tightening
• Automatic shut off at final torque set
Direction
Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Free Air Hose Overall Square Reaction
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·m] [Ibf·ft]
Speed Pressure Dia. Length Drive Arm
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [MPa] [mm] [mm] [mm] (Sold Separately) [kg]
AP220N 100-220 AP22 10-22 AP160F 80-160 5 277
10 1 275 19.0 SA400N/UA450N 4.7
AP400N 200-400 AP40 20-40 AP300F 150-300 10 175
AP700N 300-700 20 AP70 30-70 2 AP500F 220-500 10 79 364 SA700N/UA900N 6.7
0.5 φ12 25.4
AP1200N 600-1200 50 AP120 60-120 5 AP900F 450-900 25 46 375 SA1200N/UA1800N 8.1
AP2200N 1000-2200 AP220 110-220 AP1600F 800-1600 50 19.2 508 31.75 UA3000N 15
100 10
AP4000N 2000-4000 AP400 200-400 AP3000F 1500-3000 100 12 541 38.1 UA4500N 22

Note 1. Reaction arm, such as UA or SA, must be used when operating AP models in order to absorb reaction
force.
2. Use pneumatic sockets only.
3. S.Q. Drive Through Hole
Standard Accessories W5 hex key

AP400N AP2200N

Fully-Automatic Electric
DAP Torque Wrench
Assembly

• Electric version of AP
Pistol Electric Power Graduation Trigger

Direction Accuracy ±5%


Torque Range Torque Range Free Overall Square
Metric Voltage Reaction Arm Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·m] Speed Length Drive
Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] AC [V] [mm] [mm] (Sold Separately) [kg]
DAP220N 100-220 DAP22 10-22 314
10 1 AC100V 318 19.0 SA400N/UA450N 5.4
DAP400N 200-400 DAP40 20-40 199
±10%
DAP700N 300-700 20 DAP70 30-70 2 90 400 SA700N/UA900N 8.2
50/60Hz 25.4
DAP1200N 600-1200 50 DAP120 60-120 5 53 418 SA1200N/UA1800N 9.4

Note 1. DAP has 2 types, A-type for clockwise tightening, and B-type for clockwise tightening + reverse mode.
Torque control is available only for clockwise direction for both type.
2. Power cable is 2.5m length.
DAP700N 3. Reaction arm is optional.
4. Reaction arm is a must for using this model.
5. Reaction arm, such as UA or SA, must be used when operating DAP models in order to absorb reaction
force.
6. Use pneumatic sockets only.
7. S.Q. Drive Through Hole
8. It is designed for 100V usage only.
Standard Accessories W5 hex key

10:1 Ratio
AP/DAP Optional Accessories

Shell Arm
DECA Torque Multiplier
Body + Universal Arm

SA Light Weight Reaction Arm


RoHS

Power Torque Tools


Body
• Multiplied torque output by 10
RoHS
• Ideal for applying high torque
values with less force

DECA900N Universal Arm


Standard Socket Length
Model
[mm]
Accuracy ±5%
SA400N 50 Output Torque Dimension [mm]
SA700N 62 Torque Weight Applicable
Model [N·m] [kgf·m] [lbf·ft] Overall Output Input
SA1200N 62 Ratio Dia. Universal Arm
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Length Sq. Drive Sq. Drive [kg]
DECA450N 90-450 9-45 65-325 195 52 19.0 9.5 2 UA450N
Universal Arm DECA900N 180-900 18-90 130-650 541 63 3.4 UA900N

UA Heavy Duty Reaction Arm


DECA1800N
DECA3000N
360-1800
600-3000
36-180
60-300
260-1300
434-2170 10:1
270
324
78
95
25.4

31.75
12.7

19.0
5.7
10
UA1800N
UA3000N
DECA4500N 900-4500 90-450 650-3250 367 110 38.1 12.5 UA4500N
RoHS DECA9000N 1800-9000 180-900 1300-6500 464 140 50.8 34 UA9000N
25.4
DECA18000N 3600-18000 360-1800 2600-13000 540 172 63.5 60 UA18000N

Note 1. Universal Arm is optional.


2. DECA9000N and DECA18000N are supplied upon request.
3. S.Q. Drive Through Hole
Standard Accessories 1. Metal Case for DECA450N-DECA900N only
Model Weight [kg] 2. Portable Handle for DECA4500N-DECA9000N only
UA450N 1.2 3. Metal Case Caster for DECA18000N only
UA900N 2.6
UA1800N 4
UA3000N 7.2
UA4500N 10.9
UA9000N 18
UA18000N 30

51
Multiple Unit/ Automatic Straight Pneumatic Graduation Master Valve Operation RoHS
ME/MC Pneumatic
Straight Style
• Several units used simultaneously with loader
• Fully automatic tightening for complex bolt configurations
Direction Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range
Free Air Hose Overall Square
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm/kgf·m] [lbf·in/lbf·ft]
Speed Pressure Dia. Length Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [Mpa] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
ME25N 10-25 M250E2 100-250 M250E2-A 90-220 1050 420.6 (457.6) 9.5 4.7
0.5 5 5
ME45N 20-45 M450E2 200-450 M450E2-A 200-400 540
5.3
ME80N 35-80 1 M800E2 350-800 10 M800E2-A 310-700 10 310 0.4 φ7.5 424
12.7
lbf·ft lbf·ft (461)
ME126N 50-126 2
M1260E2 500-1260 20 M1260E2-A 35-90 2 200 5.7
kgf·m kgf·m
MC220N 100-220 M22C 10-22 M22C-A 80-160 277
10 1 10 287.5 19.0 4.6
MC400N 200-400 M40C 20-40 M40C-A 150-300 175
MC700N 300-700 20 M70C 30-70 2 M70C-A 220-500 20 79 376 6.7
0.5 φ8 25.4
MC1200N 600-1200 50 M120C 60-120 5 M120C-A 450-900 50 46 388 8.1
MC2200N 1000-2200 M220C 100-220 M220C-A 700-1600 19.2 491 31.75 17
100 10 100
MC4000N 2000-4000 M400C 200-400 M400C-A 1500-3000 12 522 38.1 24
Note 1. Overall length in ( ) is the length with TC sensor.
2. Auto-reverse/auto-reset functions.
3. For designing a multi-spindle system, check the PCD, minimum distance between the spindles.
4. Add “–TC” for sensor-equipped version.
5. For first-time user, consult Tohnichi for assistance.
ME126N MC400N-TC Standard Accessories Torque adjusting bar

Multiple Unit/
MG/MF Pneumatic Straight
Automatic Straight

• Several units used simultaneously with loader


Pneumatic Graduation Master Valve Operation RoHS

Direction Style • Fully automatic tightening for complex bolt configurations


Accuracy ±5%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Free Air Hose Overall Bit
Metric American Weight
S.I. Model [cN·m/N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in] Speed Pressure Dia. Length Holder
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [r.p.m] [Mpa] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
cN·m cN·m kgf·cm kgf·cm
MG120CN 40-120 1 M12G 4-12 0.1 M12G-A 4-10 0.2 720 287-
φ5 0.68
MG250CN 100-250 2.5 M25G 10-25 0.25 M25G-A 8-22 0.5 350 279
6.35
N·m N·m 0.4
Hex
MF6N 3-6 0.1 M60F 30-60 1 M60F-A 25-50 1 1000 411-
MF12N φ6 2.0
MF12N 6-12 0.2 M120F 60-120 2 M120F-A 50-100 2 500 403
Note 1. MG/MF is 6.35 HEX bit holder type.
2. For designing a multi-spindle system, check the PCD, minimum distance between the spindles.
3. For first-time user, consult Tohnichi for assistance.
Standard Accessories Torque adjusting key

Optional Accessories for Multiple Unit


Handle Valve, Supportive Handle
Part # Type Air Outlet Overall Length [mm] Application
188 Handle Valve 3/8 135 For Direct Connection
189 Handle Valve 1/8 Master Valve
Power Torque Tools

125
187 Handle Assist - -

Switch Handle, Switch Master Valve


Part # Type Application Air Outlet × Air Supply × Number of Branch
Part # Application
331 Start Switch Handle Multiple Unit Start Switch (ΦD) × (φd) × (n)
332 Reset Switch Handle Reset Switch 195 MF 1/2 × 1/4 × 4
333 Quick Reverse Handle Emergency Reset Switch 196 ME 1/2 × 1/4 × 6
197 3/4 × 3/8 × 2
Slide Drive for ME, DCME 198 MC 1 × 3/8 × 4
Model 199 1 × 3/8 × 6
FDME25N
FDME80N Slide Drive for MC
FDME126N Model
FDME400N FDMC400N
FDME1200N FDMC1200N

Torque Sensor
Model Applicable Model
TC-ME2 ME
TC-MCA MC220N, MC400N
TC-MCB-2 MC700N
TC-MCB MC1200N

Related Products
Daily inspection/calibration devices for power torque tools

ST20N3-G ST1000N3-G TCF20N TCR18N CD5


Torque checking for multi-spindle nut Fixed typed torque sensor to calibrate power Rotary type torque sensor capable of Display of torque value measured by strain
runners (P.56) tools (P.60) measuring rotating objects (P.60) gauge sensor (P.64)

52
Digital Torque Calibration Digital Manual Rotary Direct Reading Loading Device RoHS
TDT3-G Screwdriver Tester
• Ideal for testing click and indicating type torque screwdrivers
• Newly added judgment function and USB output
Direction
• Multiple units of measure through keypad setup
• Optional TDTLA3 for testing small torque wrenches and LTA for indicating type
torque screwdrivers
Accuracy ±1%+1digit
Dimensions
Torque Range
Inlet Drive [mm] Weight
Model
cN·m kgf·cm ozf·in Ibf·in Overall
Width Height
Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit [mm] Length [kg]
TDT60CN3-G 2-60 0.005 0.2-6 0.0005 3-80 0.005 0.2-5 0.0005 6.35 Hex (Male)
230 220 225 11
TDT600CN3-G with TDT600CN3-G 20-600 0.05 2-60 0.005 30-800 0.05 2-50 0.005 with a groove (0.7mm)
loading device (Model: STA)
Note 1. Loading device keeps stable measuring conditions to avoid reading errors.
2. Max 1,000 measured data can be stored.
Standard Accessories 1. AC Adapter/BA-6, 2. Loading Device/STA

TDT3-G Optional Accessories Printer (P.65)


Connecting Cable (P.47) Model
Part # Applicable Model EPP16M3
383 TDT3-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3
385 TDT3-G ➝ PC Data Filing System (P.64)
Model Media
Battery Pack (P.47) DFS CD-ROM
TDT600CN3-G with loading TDT600CN3-G with loading Model
device (Model: TDTLA3) device (Model: LTA) BP-100-3 Hex Adapter
* Sold separately * Sold separately
Part # Description
Loading Device 480 1/4-5.5-8-12
Calibration Kit for TDT3-G Model 481 1/4-6-10-13
* Sold separately. TDTLA3 482 1/4-7-11-14
Refer to page 61. LTA 483 1/4-16-19-22
STA 484 1/4-17-21-24
As for TDTLA3, TDT60CN3-G measures 2-60 cN·m and
TDT600CN3-G measures 20-600cN·m range of torque wrenches. Loading Device Connecting Adapter for TDT/TDT2-G
LTA is for direct reading torque drivers such as FTD and STC. Part # Description
STA is for tightening torque driver such as RTD and LTD. 485 TDTLA3 to TDT, TDT2-G
486 STA, LTA to TDT, TDT2-G

Excel Receiver Software


The Excel Receiver software allows for the transfer of collected torque data from
various Tohnichi digital torque equipment into a Microsoft Excel worksheet.
Tohnichi also provides customized software upon request.

Excel Receiver is compatible with the following equipment:


ExRcv

CEM100N3×15D-G CTB100N2×15D-G

CEM3-G: ExRcv for CEM CTB2-G: ExRcv for CTB


CPT-G: ExRcv for CPT
Torque Tester/Checker

TDT600CN3-G

TDT600CN3-G+TDTLA3 DOTE100N3-G LC200N3-G ST50N3-3/8-G ST1000N3-G-BT

TDT3-G: ExRcv for TDT DOTE3-G: ExRcv for DOTE LC3-G: ExRcv for LC ST3-G: ExRcv for ST

ATGE5CN-G

BTGE200CN-G 2TME500CN2 CD5 STC200CN2-G

ATGE-G/BTGE-G: ExRcv for ABTGE TME2: ExRcv for TME CD5: ExRcv for CD STC2-G: ExRcv for STC2-G

53
DOTE3-G Digital Torque
Wrench
Calibration Digital

• Multiple units of measure through keypad setup


Manual Handle Direct Reading RoHS

Direction Tester • "Loading system" stabilizes wrench during calibration procedure for optimal
results.
• RS232C output
• Max. 99 measured data can be stored.
Accuracy ±1%+1digit
Torque Range Torque Wrench Inlet
Weight
Model cN·m N·m kgf·cm kgf·m lbf·in lbf·ft Max. Effective Drive
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Length [mm] [mm] [kg]
200.0- 2.000- 20.00- 18.00-
DOTE20N3-G 0.5 0.005 0.05 - - 0.05 - -
2000.0 20.000 200.00 180.00
9.5
5.00- 50.0- 44.0- 3.60-
DOTE50N3-G - - 0.01 0.1 - - 0.1 0.01 410 11
50.00 500.0 440.0 36.00
10.00- 100.0- 88.0- 7.30-
DOTE100N3-G - - 0.02 0.2 - - 0.2 0.02
100.00 1000.0 880.0 73.00
12.7
20.00- 200.0- 170.0- 15.00-
DOTE200N3-G - - 0.05 0.5 - - 0.5 0.05 660 13
200.00 2000.0 1700.0 150.00
DOTE100N3-G 50.0- 5.00- 440- 36.0-
DOTE500N3-G - - 0.1 - - 0.01 1 0.1 1020 19.0 24
500.0 50.00 4400 360.0
100.0- 10.00- 880- 73.0-
DOTE1000N3-G - - 0.2 - - 0.02 2 0.2 1650 25.4 45
1000.0 100.00 8800 730.0

DOTE3-G-MD RoHS Note 1. Auto-zero adjustment function.


2. Statistical function includes the number of sampling, max/min/mean values.

DOTE3-G with Motor Driven Loading Device


Model DOTE3-G Standard Accessories
DOTE20N3-G-MD Down Adapter (Female) Hex Adapter (Male) AC Adapter
Model
DOTE50N3-G-MD Part # [mm] [mm] (Power Supply)
DOTE100N3-G-MD DOTE20N3-G
296/DA3-2 (P.65)
DOTE200N3-G-MD DOTE50N3-G 6.35 10, 13, 19
DOTE500N3-G-MD 277 (P.41) 12, 14, 17
DOTE100N3-G BA-6
DOTE1000N3-G-MD 297/DA4-3 (P.65) 9.5
(AC100-240V±10%)
DOTE200N3-G - - 17, 22, 27/19, 24, 30
DOTE500N3-G - - 22, 27, 29/30, 32, 36
DOTE1000N3-G 299/DA8-6 (P.65) 19.0 34, 41/46, 50

DOTE3-G Optional Accessories


Hex Adapter Battery Pack (P.47)
Part # Size [mm] Model
285 3/8-7-8-9 BP-100-3
286 1/2-16-18-21
287 1/2-17-22-27 Printer (P.65)
288 1/2-19-24-30 Model
EPP16M3
DOTE100N3-G-MD Connecting Cable (P.47)
Part # Applicable Model Data Filing System (P.64)
383 DOTE3-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3 (D-SUB 9 Pin Female) Model Media
Note 1. ( ) shows pin shape of the connecting DFS CD-ROM
cables.
2. Contact Tohnichi for other types of
connecting cables.

Analog Torque Wrench


DOT Tester
Calibration

• Dial indicating
Dial Indicating Manual Handle Direct Reading RoHS

Direction • For clockwise testing


Torque Tester/Checker

• Mechanical loading device


Accuracy ±2%

Torque Standard Accessory


Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Inlet
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Wrench Max. Drive Weight Down Adapter Hex Adapter
S.I.Model
Model Model Effective (Female) (Male)
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Length [mm] [mm] [kg] [mm] [mm]
lbf·in lbf·in
DOT35N 5-35.0 0.1 350DOT 50-350 1 DOT300I 50-300 1 #296
9.5 10, 13, 19
DOT50N 5-50.0 0.2 500DOT 50-500 2 DOT430I 50-430 2 410 8 (6.3)
12, 14, 17
#277 (6.4),
DOT100N 10-100.0 0.5 1000DOT 100-1000 5 DOT1000I 100-1000 5 12.7
#297 (9.5)
lbf·ft lbf·ft
17, 22, 27
DOT300N 30-300 1 3000DOT 300-3000 10 DOT200F 20-200 1 660 10 -
19 19, 24, 30
22, 27, 29
DOT700N 70-700 2 7000DOT 700-7000 20 DOT500F 50-500 2 1260 25 -
DOT100N 30, 32, 36

Note Measurement for clockwise direction only.


DOT-MD
Calibration Kit for DOTE3-G/DOT
DOT with Motor Driven Loading Device
* Sold separately.
S.I. Model Metric Model American Model
Refer to page 61.
DOT35N-MD 350DOT-MD DOT300I-MD
DOT50N-MD 5000DOT-MD DOT430I-MD
DOT100N-MD 1000DOT-MD DOT1000I-MD
DOT300N-MD 3000DOT-MD DOT200F-MD
DOT700N-MD 7000DOT-MD DOT500F-MD

54
Fully Automatic Digital
TF Torque Wrench Tester
Calibration Digital

• Tool Management System with computer


Electric Power Direct Reading Fully Automatic

Direction • Ideal for Calibration Labs


• Fully automatic testing, judging, and data processing Accuracy ±1%+1digit
Torque Range
Model CH [N·m] [kgf·cm] [kgf·m] [lbf·in] [lbf·ft]
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit
1 5-200 0.05 50-2000 0.5 0.5-20 0.005 50-1700 0.5 5-140 0.05
TF200N
2 0.5-20 0.005 5-200 0.05 0.05-2 0.0005 5-170 0.05 0.5-14 0.005
1 20-500 0.2 200-5000 2 2-50 0.02 200-4500 2 20-370 0.2
TF500N
2 2-50 0.02 20-500 0.2 0.2-5 0.002 20-450 0.2 2-37 0.02
TF2000N 1 25-1000 0.25 250-10000 2.5 2.5-100 0.025 250-8500 2.5 25-700 0.25
TF1000N 2 5-200 0.05 50-2000 0.5 0.5-20 0.005 50-1700 0.5 5-140 0.05
TF Standard Accessories 3 0.5-20 0.005 5-200 0.05 0.05-2 0.0005 5-170 0.05 0.5-14 0.005
1 100-2100 1 1000-21000 10 10-210 0.1 1000-18000 10 100-1500 1
Hex Adapter, Ratchet Adapter, and
TF2000N 2 20-500 0.2 200-5000 2 2-50 0.02 200-4500 2 20-370 0.2
Down Adapter 3 2-50 0.02 20-500 0.2 0.2-5 0.002 20-450 0.2 2-37 0.02
Hex Adapter Ratchet Adapter Down Adapter 1 200-3000 1 2000-30000 10 20-300 0.1 2000-25000 10 200-2000 1
Model
Dimensions [mm] Model Model TF3000N 2 100-2100 1 1000-21000 10 10-210 0.1 1000-18000 10 100-1500 1
12.7-17, 22, 27 3 20-500 0.2 200-5000 2 2-50 0.02 200-4500 2 20-370 0.2
12.7-19, 24, 30 DA3-2
TF200N
9.53-10, 13, 19 DA4-3 Standard Accessories 2m × 2P Flat Type Plug
9.53-12, 14, 17 RA3mk2
RA4mk2
19.05-W22, 27, 29 TF Specifications and Dimension
19.05-W30, 32, 36 DA3-2
TF500N
9.53-W10, 13, 19 DA6-4 Torque Wrench Max. Inlet Drive Dimensions [mm] Weight
9.53-W12, 14, 17 Model CH
Effective Length [mm] [mm] Overall Length Width Height [kg]
25.4-36, 46 1 1550 12.7
25.4-41, 51 TF200N 240
RA3mk2 2 1480 9.53
12.7-17, 22, 27 1860
TF1000N RA4mk2 1 1550 19.05
12.7-19, 24, 30
RA8mk2 TF500N 315
9.53-10, 13, 19 2 1480 9.53
9.53-12, 14, 17 DA3-2
DA4-3 1 1650 25.4
25.4-36, 46 DA8-6 TF1000N 2 1550 12.7 2160 380
25.4-41, 50
RA3mk2 3 1480 9.53 550 930
19.05-22, 27, 29
TF2000N RA6mk2
19.05-30, 32, 36 1 2150 25.4
RA8mk2
9.53-10, 13, 19 TF2000N 2 1550 19.05 2660 415
9.53-12, 14, 17
3 1480 9.53
38.1-W36, 46
1 2650 38.1
38.1-W41, 50
RA6mk2 DA6-4 TF3000N 2 2150 25.4 3160 450
25.4-W36, 46
TF3000N RA8mk2 DA8-6
25.4-W41, 50 3 1550 19.05
RA12 DA12-8
19.05-W22, 27, 29
19.05-W30, 32, 36

Note Refer to page 65. TF: The tester performs automatic measurement and judgment.
3 Types of Measurement:
Calibration Kit for TF (1) Click type torque wrench measurement
* Sold separately. (2) Direct type reading torque wrench measurement
Refer to page 61. (3) Manual measurement: free set measurement points, number of counts, and
accuracy when checking unregistered wrenches, or single-value preset torque
wrenches.

Digital Torque
TCC2-G Wrench Tester
Calibration Digital Manual Handle Direct Reading

• Torque calibrator with data management software with wide torque range
Direction • Calibration, adjustment, and data management for torque wrenches
• Multiple measuring unit
MEASUREMENT

Serial Number
TOH000-A12345
Model Name
CEM100N3X15D
Ch
1
Accuracy (%)
3.0
13/8/9

Click Type
14:00 • Slate PC controller Accuracy ±1%+1digit

Torque Tester/Checker
esc

Zero
0.0000 N.m
Dimensions
Torque Range Torque Wrench
Set Torque 1 2 3 4 5

Clear 20.000

40.000
20.000

40.000
20.000

44.000
20.000

40.000
20.000

40.000
20.000

40.000
Torque Range Torque Range
MEMORY
60.000

80.000
60.000

80.000
60.000

80.000
60.000

80.000
63.500

80.000
60.000

80.000

Max. Effective Inlet Drive [mm] Weight


[N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in]
100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00

Model CH
Length Overall
Width Height
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [mm] Length [kg]
1 4-100 0.01 40-1000 0.1 35.5-885 0.1 575 12.7
TCC100N2-G
2 1-25 0.002 10-250 0.02 9-220 0.02 482 9.53
714 388 375 35
1 4-100 0.01 40-1000 0.1 35.5-885 0.1 575 12.7
TCC100N2-D-G
2 20-600 cN·m 0.05 cN·m 2-60 0.005 2-50 0.005 482 6.35
1 20-500 0.05 200-5000 0.5 180-4400 0.5 1035 19.05
TCC500N2-G 1206 502 430 75
2 4-100 0.01 40-1000 0.1 36-880 0.1 769 12.7
1 50-1000 0.1 500-10000 1 445-8800 1 1700 25.4
TCC1000N2-G 1906 574 526 115
2 20-500 0.05 200-5000 0.5 180-4400 0.5 1212 19.05
TCC2-G Standard Accessories
DOWN TCC2-G Specifications
Model Hex Adapter Others
ADAPTER
Display 10 inch slate PC
DA3-2
TCC100N2-G 12.7-W10, 13, 19 Torque wrench/driver registration date, measurement date memory (model, serial number,
DA4-3
12.7-W12, 14, 17 measurement point, measurement count, accuracy level, channel, measurer, past record)
TCC100N2-D-G DA4-3 (1) Cradle for Tool Management Function Maximum data amount (1000pcs worth) is based on testing torque wrenches of single force
12.7-W10, 13, 19 PC display direction.
12.7-W12, 14, 17 DA4-3 (2) AC adapter When testing bi-direction torque wrenches such as BQSP, it will be less than 1000pcs)
TCC500N2-G for PC
19.05-W17, 22, 27 DA6-4 Measurement Mode Click mode / direct reading mode / manual mode
19.05-W19, 24, 30 display
(3) Power Zero Adjustment Automatic (press C key)
19.05-W17, 22, 27 Operating Temperature [°C] 0 ~ 40
cable
19.05-W19, 24, 30 DA6-4
TCC1000N2-G Power [V] 100 ~ 240V 50/60Hz
25.4-W36, 46 DA8-6
25.4-W41, 50

Note Refer to page 65. Calibration Kit for TCC2-G


* Sold separately. Refer to page 61.

55
LC3-G Torque
Checker
Wrench Line Checking Digital

• For daily inspections of torque wrenches


Manual Loading Direct Reading RoHS

Direction • Newly added judgment function and USB output


• Multiple units of measure through keypad setup
Accuracy ±1%+1digit

LC200N3-G Torque Range Inlet


Description Mode cN·m N·m kgf·cm kgf·m lbf·in lbf·ft Drive Weight
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] [kg]
Run 50.0- 2000.0 0.500-20.000 5.00-200.00 - - 5.00-174.00 - -
0.2 0.002 0.02 0.02
50.0-99.8 0.500-0.998 5.00-9.98 - - 5.00-9.98 - -
LC20N3-G 9.5
Peak 100-999 1 1.00-9.99 0.01 10.0-99.9 0.1 - - 10.0-99.9 0.1 - -
1000-2000 10 10.0-20.0 0.1 10-200 1 - - 100-174 1 - -
10.5
Run - - 5.00-200.00 50.0-2000.0 - - 50.0-1740.0 4.00-140.00
0.02 0.2 0.2 0.02
- - 5.00-9.98 50.0-99.8 - - 50.0-99.8 4.00-9.98
LC200N3-G 12.7
Peak - - 10.0-99.9 0.1 100-999 1 - - 100-999 1 10.0-99.9 0.1
- - 100-200 1 1000-2000 10 - - 1000-1740 10 100-140 1
Run - - 50.0-1000.0 - - 5.00-100.00 500-8800 36.8-735.0
0.1 0.01 1 0.1
LC1000N3-G - - 50.0-99.9 - - 5.00-9.99 500-999 36.8-99.9 19.0 34
Peak
- - 100-1000 1 - - 10.0-100.0 0.1 1000-8800 10 100-735 1
Run - - 100.0-1400.0 0.2 - - 10.00-140.00 0.02 900-12000 75.0-1000.0
LC1000N3-G 2 0.2
- - 100-999 1 - - 10.0-99.9 0.1 900-998 75.0-99.8
LC1400N3-G 25.4 39
Peak - - 1000-1400 10 - - 100-140 1 1000-9990 10 100-1000 1
LC3-G Standard Accessories - - - - - - - - 10000-12000 100 - -

Hexagon Head Adapter Note 1. Dimensions: L278mm × W160mm × H167mm (LC20N3-G, LC200N3-G)
L500mm × W290mm × H186mm (LC1000N3-G)
Applicable Square Drive Hex Size (Male) L500mm × W313mm × H186mm (LC1400N3-G)
Part #
Model [mm] [mm] 2. TCL, calibration kit is optional.
282 LC20N3-G 9.5 8, 10, 12, 13, 14, 17 3. Max. 1000 measured data can be stored.
280 LC200N3-G 12.7 8, 10, 12, 13, 14, 17, 19, 22 Standard Accessories AC Adapter/BA-6, AC100-240V±10%
Socket Adapter (P.41)
Applicable Inlet Drive Hex Size (Male) LC3-G Optional Accessories
Part #
Model [mm] [mm]
Socket Adapter (P.41) Printer (P.65)
1282 LC20N3-G 6.35 9.5
Square Drive Hex Size (Male) Model
1280 LC200N3-G 9.5 12.7 Part # Applicable model
[mm] [mm] EPP16M3
274 LC1000N3-G 12.7 19.0 270 LC20N3-G 6.35 9.5
276 LC1400N3-G 19.0 25.4 272 LC200N3-G 9.5 12.7 Data Filing System (P.64)
Model Media
Connecting Cable (P.47)
Calibration Kit for LC3-G/ST3-G Part # Applicable Model
DFS CD-ROM

* Sold separately. Refer to page 61.


383 LC3-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3 Battery Pack (P.47)
385 LC3-G ➝ PC Model
Note Contact Tohnichi for other connector shapes. BP-100-3

SPINTORK/Rotary
ST3-G Peak Torque Meter
Checking Digital

• Ideal for checking nutrunner torque output and angle


Re-Chargeable Direct Reading RoHS

ST3-G-BT • Data output through USB (ST3-G) and Bluetooth® (ST3-G-BT)


• Tightening torque value can be detected by every 1° degree in Bluetooth®
Direction version.

ST3-G/ST3-G-BT Specifications
ST1000N3-G-BT Torque Accuracy +/- 1% +1digit
Angle Range 0 to 999°
Angle 1 digit 1°
Angle Accuracy +/- 2°+1digit
Measuring Direction Bi-direction
7 segment LCD; Unit, Battery life, Direction
ST15N3-6.35-G ST50N3-3/8-G
Display Counter value: 3 digits (3mm height)
Torque Tester/Checker

Torque and angle value: 3 digits (7mm height)


ST3-G/ST3-G-BT Optional Accessories Measuring Mode PEAK/RUN
Data Memory 999
Extension Bar Data Output USB / Bluetooth® -BT models
Part # Applicable Model Continuous Duty 10 hours / 5 to 8 hours -BT models
283 ST10N3-G/-BT Power Buit-in Ni-MH (Nickel hydrogen) battery pack
281 ST20N3-G/-BT, ST50N3-3/8-G/-BT Operating Temperature [°C] 0~40
247 ST50N3-1/2-G/-BT, ST100N3-G/-BT, ST200N3-G/-BT BT Communication Distance 10m
248 ST500N3-G/-BT Auto Memory/Reset (0.5-5 seconds variable), Auto Power Off (3/10/30 mins, Non),
249 ST1000N3-G/-BT Other Functions
Display of remaining battery level (4 levels)
Accuracy ±1%+1digit
Torque Range Overall Inlet/Outlet
Model Weight
N.m cN.m kgf.cm kgf.m ozf.in lbf.in lbf.ft Length Drive
Standard Version Bluetooth® Version Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit Min.-Max. 1digit [mm] [mm] [kg]
ST10N3-G ST10N3-G-BT 2-10 0.01 200-1000 1 20-100 0.1 0.2-1 0.001 285-1400 1 18-88 0.1 1.5-7.3 0.01 75 6.35
ST15N3-6.35-G ST15N3-6.35-G-BT 4-15 400-1500 40-150 0.4-1.5 570-2100 36-131 3-11 106.5 Hex 6.35
0.02 2 0.2 0.002 2 0.2 0.02
ST20N3-G ST20N3-G-BT 4-20 400-2000 40-200 0.4-2 570-2800 36-175 3-14.5
9.53
ST50N3-3/8-G ST50N3-3/8-G-BT 0.25
10-50 0.05 1000-5000 5 100-500 0.5 1-5 0.005 1420-7000 5 90-440 0.5 7.5-36.5 0.05
ST50N3-1/2-G ST50N3-1/2-G-BT 75
ST100N3-G ST100N3-G-BT 20-100 0.1 - - 200-1000 1 2-10 0.01 - - 180-880 1 15-73 0.1 12.7
ST200N3-G ST200N3-G-BT 40-200 0.2 - - 400-2000 2 4-20 0.02 - - 360-1750 2 30-145 0.2
ST500N3-G ST500N3-G-BT 100-500 0.5 - - 1000-5000 5 10-50 0.05 - - 900-4400 5 75-365 0.5 120 19.05
1.3
ST1000N3-G ST1000N3-G-BT 200-1000 1 - - - - 20-100 0.1 - - - - 150-735 1 135 25.4

Note 1. Not for use with impact wrenches.


2. Graph of angle and torque can be created in Bluetooth® version.
3. Data output of Bluetooth® version is through Bluetooth® only.
4. Refer to page 31 for condition of wireless equipment in each country for Bluetooth® version.
Standard Accessories 1. Quick Battery Charger/BC-4-2 2. CD-ROM (USB Driver) 3. USB Connecting Cable/384 4. Carrying Case

56
Analog Torque Dial Indicating 3-jaw Chuck Direct Reading RoHS
ATG/BTG Gauge
• Compact portable handheld design
• Top and side scales for easy reading
Direction
• Three fingered keyless chuck
Accuracy ±2%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Chuck Dimensions [mm]
[cN·m] Metric [gf·cm/kgf·cm] American [ozf·in/lbf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Grip Overall Outside
Model Model
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] Length Diameter [kg]
gf·cm gf·cm ozf·in ozf·in
ATG045CN 0.05-0.45 0.01 45ATG 5-45 1 ATG06Z 0.06-0.6 0.01
ATG09CN-S 0.1-0.9 90ATG-S 10-90 ATG1.5Z-S 0.2-1.5 0.02
0.02 2
ATG1.5CN-S 0.2-1.5 150ATG-S 20-150 ATG2.4Z-S 0.3-2.4 0.05
φ1-
ATG3CN-S 0.3-3 0.05 300ATG-S 30-300 5 ATG4.5Z-S 0.5-4.5 0.1 99 43.5 0.18
φ6.5
ATG6CN-S 0.6-6 0.1 600ATG-S 60-600 10 ATG9Z-S 1-9 0.2
ATG12CN-S 1-12 0.2 1200ATG-S 100-1200 20 ATG18Z-S 2-18 0.5
ATG24CN-S 3-24 0.5 2400ATG-S 300-2400 50 ATG36Z-S 4-36 0.5
ATG6CN BTG36CN - - - - - - BTG60Z-S 6-60 1
- - - - - - BTG120Z-S 10-120 2
kgf·cm kgf·cm lbf·in lbf·in
BTG15CN-S 2-15 0.2 1.5BTG-S 0.2-1.5 0.02 1.5BTG-A-S 0.1-1.5 0.02
φ1-
BTG24CN-S 3-24 2.4BTG-S 0.3-2.4 2.4BTG-A-S 0.3-2.4 0.02 135 64.2 0.52
ATG Optional Accessories BTG36CN-S 4-36
0.5
3.6BTG-S 0.4-3.6
0.05
3.6BTG-A-S 0.4-3.6 0.05
φ8.5

Part # Description BTG60CN-S 6-60 6BTG-S 0.6-6 6BTG-A-S 0.6-6 0.1


1 0.1
322 Plastic Case and Chuck BTG90CN-S 10-90 9BTG-S 1-9 9BTG-A-S 1-9 0.1
BTG150CN-S 20-150 2 15BTG-S 2-15 0.2 15BTG-A-S 2-15 0.2
Note 1. ATG045CN, 45ATG and ATG06Z are provided without side or top memory pointer.
2. “Without memory pointer” models are available. Remove “-S” from the model name when ordering.
Ex. ATG09CN, BTG15CN
3. Aluminum case and steel chuck are standard for ATG models. Plastic case and chuck can be ordered separately.

ATGE-G Digital Torque


Gauge
Digital 3-jaw Chuck

• Digital torque gauge with pull out display


Direct Reading Battery RoHS

Direction • For measurement, inspection and tightening of low torque range


• 3 way configuration; hand-held, table top or as a torque meter with testing
fixture
Accuracy ±2%+1digit
Torque Range Chuck Dimensions [mm]
Weight
Model [cN·m] [mN·m] [gf·cm] [ozf·in] Grip Overall Outside
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] Length Diameter [kg]
ATGE05CN-G 0.1-0.5 0.001 1-5 0.01 10-50 0.1 0.15-0.7 0.001
ATGE1CN-G 0.2-1 0.001 2-10 0.01 20-100 0.1 0.3-1.4 0.001
ATGE2CN-G 0.4-2 0.002 4-20 0.02 40-200 0.2 0.6-2.8 0.002
φ1-6.5 120 67 0.305
ATGE5CN-G 1-5 0.005 10-50 0.05 100-500 0.5 1.5-7 0.005
ATGE10CN-G 2-10 0.01 20-100 0.1 200-1000 1 3-14 0.01
ATGE20CN-G 4-20 0.02 40-200 0.2 400-2000 2 6-28 0.02
Note Aluminum case and steel chuck are standard for ATGE-G models. Plastic case and chuck/322 (page 59) is
sold separately.
Standard Accessories Carrying case
ATGE5CN-G

ATGE-G Common Specifications


Direction CW/CCW
7 segment LCD display,
Counter 3 digits (character height 3mm),
Display
Calibration Kit for Torque value: 4 digits (character height 7mm)

Torque Tester/Checker
Torque unit, Battery indicator, Direction
ATG/BTG/ATGE-G/BTGE-G Mode PEAK/RUN
Data Memory 999 readings
* Sold separately.
Refer to page 61. Statistic Prosessing Sample size, Max. value, Min. value, Mean value
Data Output USB output (USB mini B connector)
Power Coin-type lithium battery (CR2450)
Continuous in Use approx. 10 hours when using coin battery
Auto power off (3 min.), Auto memory reset (0.5-5) seconds variable, Auto zero adjustment, Residual
Other Functions
battery indicator (4 steps), Buzzer ON/OFF, Unit Conversion
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40
Standard Options Carrying case

57
BTGE-G Digital Torque
Gauge
Digital 3-jaw Chuck Direct Reading

• Multiple units of measure through keypad setup


Battery RoHS

Direction • For measurement, inspection and tightening of low torque ranges


• Flip-up display can be adjusted for optimal reading
Accuracy ±2%+1digit
Torque Range Chuck Dimensions [mm]
Weight
Model [cN·m] [kgf·cm] [ozf·in] [lbf·in] Grip Overall Outside
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] Length Diameter [kg]
BTGE10CN-G 2-10 0.01 0.2-1 0.001 3-14 0.01 0.2-0.88 0.001
BTGE20CN-G 4-20 0.02 0.4-2 0.002 6-28 0.02 0.4-1.7 0.002
φ1-
BTGE50CN-G 10-50 0.05 1-5 0.005 15-70 0.05 1-4.4 0.005 130 75 0.65
φ8.5
BTGE100CN-G 20-100 0.1 2-10 0.01 30-140 0.1 2-8.8 0.01
BTGE200CN-G 40-200 0.2 4-20 0.02 60-280 0.2 4-17 0.02
Note 1. Can be used for checking accuracy of torque screwdrivers.
2. Max 999 readings can be saved with statistical function max/min/mean values.

BTGE200CN-G
BTGE-G Optional Accessories BP-C1
Connecting Cable (P.47)
Part # Applicable Model Battery Pack
384 BTGE-G (USB mini B) ➝ PC (USB A) Model
BP-C1
Measurement Board
Model
809

ATG/BTG/ATGE-G/BTGE-G Optional Accessories

ATGE-G/BTGE-G Measurement stand


To firmly fix ATGE-G/BTGE-G to use as table top configuration
Part # Applicable Model
808 ATGE-G
No.808 809 BTGE-G

Table attachment
4 poles are designed to clamp objects of any shape (Chucking diameter φ10-φ58)
Part # Applicable Model
No.800 800 ATGE-G/BTGE-G

Calibration adapter for ATGE-G/BTGE-G


Adapter for calibration devices, ATGTCL/BTGTCL, to mount on ATGE-G/BTGE-G
Part # Applicable Model
No.806 806 ATGE-G
807 BTGE-G

Adapter for USB connector


External power supply adapter for ATGE-G/BTGE-G with using USB connecting cable.
Part # Applicable Model
BA-5 BA-5 ATGE-G/BTGE-G

USB connecting cable


Cable for external USB data output or connecting BA-5
Part # Applicable Model
No.384 384 ATGE-G/BTGE-G
Torque Tester/Checker

Plastic chuck
Plastic chuck for fragile objects
Part # Applicable Model
No.322 322 ATG/ATGE-G

Battery pack
Part # Applicable Model ATGE-G with table attachment and
measurment stand
BP-C1 BTGE-G

BP-C1

BTGE-G with table attachment and


AMRD torque checking with ATGE-G BMRD torque checking with measurment stand
and measurement stand, #808. BTGE-G and measurement stand,
#809.

58
Digital Torque Meter Digital Pole Clamping Direct Reading RoHS
TME2 • Ideal for testing torque on bottle caps
• Up to 99 measured data can be stored.
Direction Accuracy ±1%+1digit
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Chuck Dimensions [mm]
[cN·m] Metric [gf·cm/kgf·cm] American [ozf·in/lbf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Size Overall
Model Model Width Height
Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit Min.-Max. 1 digit [mm] Length [kg]
gf·cm gf·cm ozf·in ozf·in
3TME10CN2 2.00-10.00 0.01 3TME10CN2-M 200-1000 1 3TME10CN2-Z 2.80-14.00 0.01
3TME20CN2 4.00-20.00 0.02 3TME20CN2-M 400-2000 2 3TME20CN2-Z 5.60-28.00 0.02
φ14-
3TME50CN2 10.00-50.000 0.05 3TME50CN2-M 1000-5000 5 3TME50CN2-Z 14.00-70.00 0.05 252 158 185 3.5
φ110
kgf·cm kgf·cm
3TME100CN2 20.0-100.0 0.1 3TME100CN2-M 2.00-10.00 0.01 3TME100CN2-Z 28.00-140.0 0.1
lbf·in lbf·in
2TME200CN2 40.0-200.0 0.2 2TME200CN2-M 4.00-20.00 0.02 2TME200CN2-I 3.50-17.00 0.02
2TME500CN2 100.0-500.0 0.5 2TME500CN2-M 10.00-50.00 0.05 2TME500CN2-I 8.80-44.00 0.05 φ18-
331 223 283 12
2TME1000CN2 200-1000 1 2TME1000CN2-M 20.0-100.0 0.1 2TME1000CN2-I 17.6-88.00 0.1 φ190
2TME2000CN2 400-2000 2 2TME2000CN2-M 40.0-200.0 0.2 2TME2000CN2-I 35.0-175.0 0.2

Note 1. Can be used for checking accuracy of torque screwdrivers.


2. Max. 99 measured data can be stored.
3. TMTCL, calibration kit is optional.
4. Statistical Data: Hi, Lo, Sample, Ave., Range Variation, and Standard Deviation
Standard Accessories 1. AC Adapter/BA-4
2. Rubber Nail
3. Supportive Plate for 2TME2

TME2 Optional Accessories


2TME500CN2
Connecting Cable (P.47) Printer (P.65)
Part # Applicable Model Model
383 TME2 ➝ PC, EPP16M3 EPP16M3

Data Filing System (P.64)


Model Media
DFS CD-ROM

Battery Pack (P.47)


Model
BP-100-3

Analog Torque Meter


TM Pole Clamping

• Dial indicating
Direct Reading RoHS

Direction • Wide variety of torque testing ranges


Accuracy ±2%
Torque Range American Torque Range Metric Torque Range Dimensions [mm]
S.I. Model American/Metric Weight
[mN·m/cN·m] [lbf·in] [kgf·cm/gf·cm] Overall Chuck
Model Width Height
Standard With Memory Pointer Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Length Size [kg]
mN·m mN·m gf·cm gf·cm
4TM10MN 4TM10MN-S 1-10 0.2 4-TM100-A-S 0.01-0.086 0.002 10-100 2
4TM15MN 4TM15MN-S 1.5-15 4-TM150-A-S 0.02-0.13 15-150
0.5 0.005 5
4TM25MN 4TM25MN-S 2.5-25 4-TM250-A-S 0.025-0.215 25-250
4TM50MN 4TM50MN-S 5-50 1 4-TM500-A-S 0.05-0.43 0.01 50-500 10
4TM75MN 4TM75MN-S 8-75 2 4-TM750-A-S 0.08-0.65 0.02 80-750 20
φ14-
cN·m cN·m kgf·cm kgf·cm 252 158 109.5 3
φ110
3TM10CN 3TM10CN-S 1-10 0.2 3-TM1-A-S 0.1-0.86 0.02 0.1-1 0.02
3TM15CN 3TM15CN-S 1.5-15 3-TM1.5-A-S 0.15-1.3 0.15-1.5
0.5 0.05 0.05
3TM25CN 3TM25CN-S 2.5-25 3-TM2.5-A-S 0.25-2.15 0.25-2.5

Torque Tester/Checker
2TM400CN
3TM50CN 3TM50CN-S 5-50 1 3-TM5-A-S 0.5-4.3 0.1 0.5-5 0.1
3TM75CN 3TM75CN-S 8-75 3-TM7.5-A-S 0.8-6.5 0.2 0.8-7.5 0.2
2TM100CN 2TM100CN-S 10-100 2 2-TM10-A-S 1-8.6 1-10
0.2 0.2
2TM150CN 2TM150CN-S 20-150 2-TM15-A-S 2-13 2-15
2TM200CN 2TM200CN-S 30-200 2-TM20-A-S 3-17 3-20
2TM300CN 2TM300CN-S 30-300 5 2-TM30-A-S 3-26 0.5 3-30 0.5 φ18-
5TM2.5MN 331 223 133.5 10.5
2TM400CN 2TM400CN-S 40-400 2-TM40-A-S 3.5-35 4-40 φ190
2TM500CN 2TM500CN-S 50-500 2-TM50-A-S 4-43 5-50
2TM600CN 2TM600CN-S 60-600 10 2-TM60-A-S 5-50 1 6-60 1
2TM750CN 2TM750CN-S 80-750 2-TM75-A-S 7-65 8-75
Calibration Kit for TME2/TM Note “-S” models are provided with a memory pointer.

* Sold separately.
Refer to page 61. Low Capacity, below 7.5 mN·m, Torque Meter Accuracy ±2%
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Dimensions [mm]
[mN·m] Metric [gf·cm] American [ozf·in] Weight
S.I. Model Overall Chuck
Model Model Width Height
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Length Size [kg]
5TM1MN 0.2-1 5-TM10 2-10 5-TM015Z 0.02-0.15 0.005
0.05 0.5
5TM1.5MN 0.2-1.5 5-TM15 2-15 5-TM020Z 0.04-0.2
0.01 φ6-
5TM2.5MN 0.5-2.5 0.1 5-TM25 5-25 1 5-TM035Z 0.05-0.35 122 76.5 59 0.3
φ58
5TM5MN 1-5 5-TM50 10-50 5-TM070Z 0.3-0.7 0.02
0.2 2
5TM7.5MN 1-7.5 5-TM75 10-75 5-TM1Z 0.2-1 0.05

Note 1. 5TM models are supplied without memory pointer.


2. When calibrating the 5TM models, ask Tohnichi for assistance.

59
Fixed Type Torque Voltage Output Fixed RoHS
TCF Sensor
• Requires CD5 to display torque reading
Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Inlet Dimensions
[N·m] Metric [kgf·cm] American [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Weight
S.I. Model Drive Height Diamater
Model Model
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
lbf·in
TCF02N 0.02-0.2 TCF1.8 0.18-1.8 TCF1.8I 0.18-1.8
56 0.45
TCF04N 0.04-0.4 TCF3.5I 0.35-3.5
- -
TCF1N 0.1-1 TCF9I 0.9-9.0 6.35 45
TCF2N 0.2-2 TCF18 1.8-18 TCF18I 1.8-18 62.5 0.5
TCF4N 0.4-4 TCF35I 3.5-35
- -
TCF10N 1-10 TCF90I 9.0-90
TCF20N 2-20 TCF180 18-180 TCF180I 18-180 9.5 66 70 0.6
TCF40N 4-40 TCF350I 38-350
CD5 TCF20N
- - lbf·ft
*Display is sold separately. TCF100N 10-100 TCF75F 7.5-75 12.7 100 105 2.5
TCF200N 20-200 TCF1800 180-1800 TCF150F 15-150
TCF400N 40-400 TCF300F 30-300 19.0 135 140 6
- -
TCF1000N 100-1000 TCF750F 75-750
25.4 180 178 12
TCF2000N 200-2000 TCF18000 1800-18000 TCF1500F 150-1500

Note 1. TCL, calibration kit is optional.


2. Display, CD5, is sold separately.
Standard Accessories Connecting Cable

TCF Optional Accessories TP, Test Piece: Torque measurement for power torque tools
Torque Range Inlet Dimensions
S.I. Metric American Applicable Width Across Nominal Weight
Model Diameter Height
[N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] TCF Model Flats Size of
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [mm] Screw [mm] [mm] [kg]
lbf·in
TP2.5N 0.25-2.5 2.5-25 2-22 TCF02N-TCF4N 8 M4 18 58 0.08
TP18N 1.8-18 18-180 16-160 TCF10N, TCF20N 13 M6 35 83.5 0.27
lbf·ft
TP180N 18-180 180-1800 30-130 TCF40N-TCF200N 24 65 148 1.9
TP18N+TCF20N -
TP1800N 180-1800 1800-18000 130-1300 TCF400N-TCF2000N 50 140 297.5 16.8

Note 1. Adapter 4H-3 (#273) is necessary for TCF40N.


2. Adapter 8P-6 (#295) is necessary for TCF400N.

DTF, Drill Chuck: Torque measurement for axial work pieces


Dimensions
Chuck Size Square Drive
Model Applicable TCF Models Diamater Height
[mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
DTF5-2+TCF20N DTF5-3 TCF02N-TCF4N 6.35 65
Max. φ5 33
DTF5-2 TCF10N-TCF40N 9.5 61

TTF/ATF, Table and fixture: Ideal for testing torque on bottle caps
Model Chuck Size Table Dia.
Applicable TCF
TTF ATF [mm] [mm]
TTF7 φ10-70 φ70
ATF18-2 TCF02N-TCF4N
TTF11 φ14-110 φ110
ATF18 TCF10N-TCF20N
ATF18-2 TCF2N-TCF4N
TTF19 φ18-190 φ180
TTF11+ATF18+TCF20N ATF18 TCF10N-TCF20N

Note ATF attachment is required to fix TTF table.


Torque Tester/Checker

Rotary Type Torque


TCR Sensor
Voltage Output Rotary

• Captures directly applied torque


RoHS

• Requires CD5 to display torque reading


Torque Range Torque Range Torque Range Allowable Square
Metric American Height Width Weight
S.I. Model [N·m] [kgf·cm] [lbf·in/lbf·ft] Rotation Drive
Model Model
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. [r.p.m] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
lbf.in
TCR18N 1.8-18 TCR180 18-180 TCR180-A 16-160 9.5 91 76 0.9
lbf.ft 2000
TCR180N 18-180 TCR1800 180-1800 TCR1800-A 13-130 12.7 104 83 1.3
TCR700N 70-700 TCR7000 700-7000 TCR7000-A 50-500 19.0 118.5 95 2.0
1000
TCR1800N 180-1800 TCR18000 1800-18000 TCR18000-A 130-1300 25.4 138.5 110 3.6
CD5 TCR18N
Note 1. TCL, calibration kit is optional.
*Display is sold separately. 2. Display, CD5, is sold separately.
Standard Accessories Connecting Cable

Calibration Kit for TCF/TCR


* Sold separately.
Refer to page 61.

60
Calibration Kit
Calibration Kit for DOTE3-G/DOT RoHS Calibration Kit for TDT3-G RoHS
Description Model Description Applicable Model
Model
Calibration Lever Stand Reaction Unit Scale Holder Applicable Model Calibration Lever × 1, Wire × 1, Calibration Roller × 1,
TDTCL60CN TDT60CN3-G
DOT35N Scale Pan (100g) × 1, Scale Holder (1kg) × 1,
DOT50N Calibration Lever × 1, Wire × 1, Calibration Roller × 1,
DOTCL36N KL-DOTCL36N WT0.5 TDTCL600CN TDT600CN3-G
DOTE20N3-G Scale Pan (100g) × 1, Scale Holder (1kg) × 1,
RU-DOTCL100N
DOTE50N3-G
DOT100N
DOTCL100N KL-DOTCL100N
DOTE100N3-G
RoHS
KS-DOTCL WT1
DOTCL200N KL-DOTCL200N
RU-DOTCL360N
DOTE200N3-G Calibration Kit for ATG/BTG/ATGE-G/BTGE-G
DOTCL360N KL-DOTCL360N DOT300N Model Description Applicable Model
DOTE500N3-G Main Unit, Calibration Pulley × 2,
DOTCL700N KL-DOTCL700N WT5 ATGTCL24CN ATG/ATGE-G
RU-DOTCL700N DOT700N Wire × 2, Scale Pan (5g, 100g)
DOTCL1000N KL-DOTCL1000N DOTE1000N3-G
Main Unit, Calibration Pulley × 2,
BTGTCL150CN BTG/BTGE-G
Wire × 3, Scale Pan (5g, 100g)

Calibration Kit for TF RoHS Note Adapter (#807) is required when calibrating BTGE models.

Description
Model
Calibration Lever, Adapter Stand Wire Applicable Model
Calibration Kit for TME2/TM RoHS
TFTCL200N Lever × 2 TF200N
Wire × 4
TFTCL500N Adapter × 2 TF500N Model Description Applicable Model
TFTCL1000N Lever × 3 1 Set TF1000N Wire × 1, Roller × 1, Frame × 1, Bolt × 2,
2TMTCL 2TM/2TME2
TFTCL2000N Adapter × 2 TF2000N Scale Holder (1kg) × 1, Scale Pan (100g) × 1
Wire × 6
Lever × 3 Wire × 1, Roller × 1, Frame × 1,
TFTCL3000N TF3000N 3TMTCL 3TM/4TM/3TME2
Adapter × 1 Bolt × 2, Scale Pan (5g × 1, 100g × 1)

Note Supplied upon request.

Calibration Kit for LC3-G/ST3-G/TCF/TCR RoHS


Calibration Kit for TCC2-G RoHS Model Description Applicable Model
Description Optional Item Applicable Calibration Lever, Wire, TCF10N-TCF40N, TCR18N
Model TCL50N
Calibration Lever Stand Wire Scale Holder Weight Model Scale Holder (1kg), Scale Pan (100g) LC20N3-G, ST10N3-G-ST50N3-1/2-G
TCCTCL100N2 Wire × 2 100g × 1, 1kg × 1, 2kg × 2, TCC100N2-G TCL200N
Calibration Lever, Wire, TCF100N-TCF200N, TCR180N
TCCTCL100N2-D Wire × 3 1kg × 1 5kg × 3, Weight Set TCC100N2-D-G Scale Holder (1kg) LC200N3-G, ST100N3-G-ST200N3-G
500g × 1 TCL800N
Calibration Lever, Wire,
TCF400N, TCR700N, ST500N3-G
1kg × 1, 2kg × 2, Scale Holder (10kg)
TCCTCL500N2 Lever × 2 1 Set Wire × 4 1kg × 1 TCC500N2-G
5kg × 9, Weight Set
5kg × 1 TCL1000N
Calibration Lever, Wire, TCF1000N, ST1000N3-G,
1kg × 1 1kg × 1, 2kg × 2, Scale Holder (5kg) LC1000N3-G
TCCTCL1000N2 Wire × 2 TCC1000N2-G
5kg × 1 5kg × 13, Weight Set Calibration Lever, Wire, TCF2000N, TCR1800N,
TCL2000N
Scale Holder (10kg) LC1400N3-G
Note Contact Tohnichi in case you have DOTCL.
Note 1. TCL1000N and TCL2000N are supplied upon request.
2. #271 is required when calibrating ST10N2.

DOTCL100N
TFTCL2000N

Torque Tester/Checker
TDTCL600CN

TCL200N
TCCTCL100N2

ATGTCL24CN 2TMTCL

Weight RoHS
Model Weight
WP-TCL5 5kg
WP-TCL2 2kg
WP-TCL1 1kg
WS-TCL2 Weight Set (2kg)

Note 1. A dead weight is available for sale.


2. Calibration certificate for dead weight is available on request, charged
option.

61
Bolt Tension Meter Dial Indicating Hydraulic Bourdon Type
BTM/ • Bourdon type hydraulic bolt tension meter
• Measure bolt tension to determine optimal torque
B-BTM Axial Tension Axial Tension Axial Tension
Applicable Nominal Dimensions
Accuracy ±3%

Range Metric Range American Range


Diameter of Bolts Overall Overall Overall Weight
S.I. Model
[kN] Model [ton] Model [lbf]
(Minimum Length) Length Thickness Height
Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. Min.-Max. Grad. [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] [kg]
Hexagon Bolt
M16 (70), M20 (75)
M22 (80), M24 (85)
BTM400K 100-400 5 40BTM-2 10-40 0.5 40BTM-2-A 23000-90000 1000 260 64 280 12.6
Torsia Bolt
M16 (65), M20 (70)
M22 (75), M24 (80)
Standard Bolt
B-BTM13K 1.2-13 0.2 1.3B-BTM 0.12-1.3 0.02 1.3B-BTM-A 300-2800 50 M5 (20), M6 (21) 106 78 217 7.7
M7 (22), M8 (23)
Standard Bolt
B-BTM40K 4-40 0.5 4B-BTM 0.4-4 0.05 4B-BTM-A 1000-9000 100 M10 (29), M12 (31) 134 82 241 9.8
M14 (32)
Standard Bolt
BTM400K B-BTM13K B-BTM130K 12-130 2 13B-BTM 1.2-13 0.2 13B-BTM-A 3000-28000 500 M16 (41), M18 (43) 186 106 287 17.5
M20 (44), M24 (47)
Standard Bolt
B-BTM400K 40-400 5 40B-BTM 4-40 0.5 40B-BTM-A 1000-90000 1000 M27 (72), M30 (74) 280 126 369 31.0
M36 (79), M42 (84)

Note 1. BTM400K comes with a plate and bushing for torsia bolt M20 and M22. Other plates and bushings are
optional.
2. “Hexagon Bolt” in the above list stands for the high-tensile hexagon bolt for friction bonding.
Standard Accessories Plate, Bushing, Spanner for plate, Bolt for plate, Storage Case, Calibration Certificate

BTM Optional Accessories


Bushing for Hexagon Bolt Bushing for Torsia Bolt Plate for Torsia Bolt/Hexagon Bolt
Applicable Nominal Applicable Nominal Applicable Nominal
Part # Part # Part #
Diameter of Bolts Diameter of Bolts Diameter of Bolts
650 M16 665 M16 669 M16
651 M20 666 M20 670 M20
652 M22 667 M22 671 M22
653 M24 668 M24 672 M24

Bolt Tension • Creates consistent bolt tension


Fcon Stabilization • Applied to fasteners and nuts
• Acquisition of patent in EU.
RoHS
Model
Axial Tension Stability Characteristics
Fcon
Test conditions
Sales Unit: 10pcs/case Axial tension 80 KN Fluctuating coefficient
Content: 90g/bottle Hex bolt, nut, washer
M16 × 2 (8.8) Average torque coefficient

Average Torque coefficient


Torque fluctuating coefficient

Zinc chromate
30 times of test

Fcon Machine oil Lubricant Other


Fcon
Characteristic of axial tension stabilization
Torque coefficient calculated by formula K = t/(d × f)
T = tightening torque, d = nominal size of screw,
F = axial tension
Torque fluctuating coefficient =
torque coefficient standard deviation/average torque coefficient

Influence of Tightening Speed Influence of Temperature


Force Measurement

Fcon Screw size: M10 × 1.5


Zinc plated chromate Axial tension 80 KN
Machine oil Bearing surface: HRC 40 polished Hex bolt, nut, washer
Instrument

Axial tension: 30 KN M16 × 2 (8.8)


Number of test: 5
Torque coefficient

Zinc chromate
Torque coefficient

Machine oil

Fcon

Tightening operation temperature (°C)


Tightening speed (r.p.m)
Influence of temperature on torque coefficient
Influence of tightening speed on torque coefficient

62
Ultrasonic Tension
TT2000 Meter
Digital Direct Reading

• Non-destructive axial bolt tension tester


• Input information regarding fastener & materials
• Sound wave lengths are measured and compared.

Model
TT2000
TT2000C
TT2000M

TT2000 TT2000 Specifications


Measuring Range 5-10,000mm (Steel material)
Applicable Length of Bolt 50-9,000mm
Applicable Nominal Diameter of Bolt φ6mm dia or more (Applicable for less than φ6mm dia. with an optional sensor)
Ultrasonic Wave Frequency 0.5-15 MHz
Time Axis Resolution 5ns
Result of Measurement Bolt initial length (mm), Stress (Mpa), Elongation (mm), Propagation rate (µs)
Depends on bolt diameter and length
[Ex.] Based on the first echo measurement (steel material)
Measuring Resolution
Bolt diameter φ10, Bolt tightening length 50mm ±approx. 1.47kN
Bolt diameter φ20, Bolt tightening length 100mm ± approx. 2.94kN
Memory Capacity of Data 2,000pcs. or time pass measurement 300 items (Max. 50 kinds of different bolts can be registered)
Bolt Temperature Correction Manual input by key, Auto temperature input *1
Display Color TFT6.4 type (640 × 480dots)
8 bits serial interface (RS232C) *2
External Output
Composite output (NTSC), Alarm output (photo coupler), Encoder input *3
Power Supply AC85-130V, AC185-265V (50/60Hz) or DC12V *4
Optional Battery Portable: 2.5h use for 1.5h Charge Built -in case: 8h use for 4.5h charge
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-45
Dimensions Body: H160 × W246 × D60mm Body + Built-in battery: H160 × W246 × D246mm
Weight Body: 1.2kg Body + built-in battery:4.9kg

Note 1. Optional thermometer can be connected to TT2000C and TT2000M for auto temperature adjustment
Input temperature range is from -40˚C to 200˚C. Measurement over 60˚C requires a sensor specially
designed for high temperature.
2. RS232C connector is available only with TT2000C and TT2000M.
3. Composite output, alarm output and encoder input are available only when using a multi connector box
(TT2000M) or optional built-in battery case.
4. DC12V can be used only when using the optional portable battery or the built-in battery case.
5. Certificate of calibration is available on request, charged option.
Sensor
Magnet Holder

Bolt Holder
TT2000 Optional Accessories
Model Name
RS232C Junction Cable A
Portable Battery Cable
RS232C Junction Cable B
Battery Built-in Body
Handy Type Cover
Portable Type Cover
TT2000 Carrying Case
Portable Battery Pack
Light Shielding Hood
Carrying Case for Body with Battery Built-in Body
Axial Tension Calibrator
Model
AFC-20G
Ultrasonic Sensor
Part # Name Applicable Bolts
606 5C4.8N More than M6, L1<approx.80mm
607 5C6.4N More than M8, L1<approx.50cm
608 5C12.7N More than M14, L1<approx.2m
609 5C19.1N More than M20, L1<approx.4m

Note 1. L1 is standard bolt length with material in SCM, S-C, SS for ultrasonic wave reflection measurement
n=1.
2. Ultrasonic wave sensor is consisting of 3 parts, Sensor, Magnet Holder and Bolt Holder.
3. Standard 5C6. 4N does not include bolt holder.
4. 5C6.4N=[5: Frequency (MHZ)]
Force Measurement

[C: Oscillator Material (C: piezoelectric ceramics)]


[6.4: Oscillator Diameter, mm]
[N: Perpendicular (Normal)]
Instrument

Features of ultrasonic wave sensor


1. The magnetic holder provides stabilized force through the sensor, which provides high repeatability
measurement.
2. The bolt holder gives same position of the sensor to support more accurate measurement.

63
Compact Display Digital Sensor Contacts Direct Reading Comparator Judgment
CD5
Optional Equipment

• Digital display for Tohnichi’s torque sensor, strain gauge, products


• Adapted the Black Mask LCD making 3 different colored displays
• OK or NG judgment capability with upper or lower limit setting function

Model
CD5
CD5 Specifications
Display Negative type liquid crystal
±1/5000 (±1.0 to ±3.0mV/V)
CD5 Optional Accessories Resolution ±1/2000 (±0.5 to ±1.0mV/V)
1/2000 (+0.1 to +3.0mV/V)
Printer Input Voltage ±3.0mV/V
Model Nonlinerity ±0.05% F.S.
EPP16M3 Accuracy Zero point drift ±0.1µV/°C (TYP.)
Gain drift ±0.01%/°C (TYP.)

CD5 Data Filing System Equivalent input calibration


Calibration by actual weight
Model Media Calibration Methods
Calibration using sensor-equipped
DFS CD-ROM torque wrench
Data Memory 1000 readings
Connecting Cable (P.47) External Input RESET/COMP/CLEAR/CHSW
Part # Applicable Model Plug RS232C compliant, Analog output,
Communication
383 CD5 ➝ PC, EPP16M3 D-SUB 9 Pin Female HI. OK, LO relay output
Power AC100-240V±10%
Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40
Dimension 150W × 190D × 94H
Weight approx. 1.8 kg

Data Tank
R-DT999 Auxiliary Infrared Input RS232C Data Output

• Infrared data collector for torque equipment


• 999 data storage
• External keypad setup functions

Model
R-DT999

R-DT999 Specifications
Data Input Infrared data input (Tohnichi format only)
R-DT999 Optional Accessories
6 digits, 14segments LCD
Display 4 digits, 7segments LCD
Printer 4 digits, 7segments LED
Model
Applicable Model CEM3-G, CEM2, ST, ST2, STC, CTA, CTB
EPP16M3
RS232C compliance,
Data Output
USB connector serial output (*USB 1.1)
R-DT999 Power DC5V 2A
Data Filing System Dimensions W80 × D125 × H32mm
Model Media Standard Accessories AC adapter (100-240V±10%)
DFS CD-ROM Operating Temperature [°C] 0-40
Weight 205g (body only)

Connecting Cable (P.47)


Part # Applicable Model Plug
575 R-DT999 ➝ PC, EPP16M3 D-SUB 9 Pin Female
584 R-DT999 ➝ PC USB A Type

Note Contact Tohnichi for other types of connector shapes.

Data Filing System/


DFS CD-ROM
Auxiliary

• Data processing software


CD

• Statistics, Standard deviation, Cp values, Charts

Model Media
DFS CD-ROM
ST3-G TME2

CD5
Connecting Cable to PC (P.47)
CEM3-G Part # Applicable Model Plug
DFS 575 CEM3-G, CTA2-G, CTB2-G, R-DT999 ➝ PC, EPP16M3 D-SUB 9 Pin Female
584 CEM3-G, CTA2-G, CTB2-G, R-DT999 ➝ PC USB A Type
383 DOTE3-G, LC3-G, TME2, TDT3-G ➝ PC, EPP16M3 D-SUB 9 Pin Female
384 ST3-G, ATGE-G, BTGE-G ➝ PC USB A Type
Maximum value, minimum value, data
Note Contact Tohnichi for other types of connector shapes.
range, mean value, standard deviation
and Cp value are calculated to make a
histogram on the display.

64
EPP16M3 Printer Auxiliary RS232C Data Input

Optional Equipment
• Printer for digital torque equipment
EPP16M3 Specifications
• Terminal Line Dot printing Printed Mwthod Thermal Line Dot
Model Total Dot 384 dots
EPP16M3 Dots per inch 203 dpi (8dot/mm)
Printing Capacity 32
Number of Dots for Character 12 × 24
EPP16M3 Optional Accessories Character Size [mm] 1.5 × 3.0
Paper Width/Print Span [mm] 58 / 48
Roll Paper Thermal Paper Outer Diameter [mm] φ50
Part # Description Max Printing Speed [mm/sec] 80
1408 Roll Paper Power AC [V] 100 - 240V ± 10% 50/60Hz
Operating Temperature [°C] 0 ~ 40
Humidity [%RH] Under 85 (No condensation)
Weight [kg] approx. 0.27

Connecting Cable
Part # Applicable Model Plug
383 DOTE3-G, LC3-G, TDT3-G, TME2, CD5
D-SUB 9 Pin Female
575 CEM3-G/CEM3-P, CTA2-G, R-DT999, CTB2-G
EPP16M3

10:1 Ratio Torque


DECA Multiplier
Auxiliary Straight

• Multiplied torque output increases by 10 times


Rotary RoHS

Body + Universal Arm


• Ideal for applying high torque values with less force
Accuracy ±5%
Output Torque Dimension [mm]
Torque Weight Applicable
Model [N·m] [kgf·m] [lbf·ft] Overall Output Input
Ratio Dia. Universal Arm
Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Min.-Max. Length Sq. Drive Sq. Drive [kg]
Body DECA450N 90-450 9-45 65-325 195 52 19.0 9.5 2 UA450N
DECA900N 180-900 18-90 130-650 541 63 3.4 UA900N
DECA1800N 360-1800 36-180 260-1300 270 78 25.4 12.7 5.7 UA1800N
DECA3000N 600-3000 60-300 434-2170 10:1 324 95 31.75 10 UA3000N
DECA4500N 900-4500 90-450 650-3250 367 110 38.1 19.0 12.5 UA4500N
DECA9000N 1800-9000 180-900 1300-6500 464 140 50.8 34 UA9000N
DECA18000N 3600-18000 360-1800 2600-13000 540 172 63.5 25.4 60 UA18000N
Note 1. Universal Arm is optional.
2. DECA9000N and DECA18000N are supplied on request.
Standard Accessories 1. Metal Case (for DECA450N-DECA900N only)
DECA900N 2. Portable Handle (for DECA4500N-DECA9000N only)
Universal Arm 3. Metal Case Caster (for DECA18000N only)

AP/DAP Optional Accessories Shell Arm Universal Arm


SA RoHS
• Light weight reaction arm UA RoHS
• Heavy duty reaction arm
Standard Socket Max. Torque Model Max. Torque [N·m] Weight [kg]
Model
Length [mm] [N·m] UA450N 450 1.2
SA400N 50 400 UA900N 900 2.6
SA700N 62 700 UA1800N 1800 4
SA1200N 62 1200 UA3000N 3000 7.2
UA4500N 4500 10.9
UA9000N 9000 18
SA UA UA18000N 18000 30
Note UA4500N/9000N/18000N are
supplied on request.

Down Adapter for Torque Wrench Testers RoHS


Adapter for Torque Wrench Tester
DA • Compact adapter to reduce the size of square drive
Dimensions [mm] Capacity Weight
Model Part #
Square Drive (Male) Square Drive (Female) Height Outside Dia. [N·m] [g]
Down Adapter DA3-2 296 9.5 6.35 12 13 14 5
DA4-3 297 12.7 9.5 15 18 70 11
DA6-4 298 19.0 12.7 19 28 220 34
DA8-6 299 25.4 19.0 26 35 750 66
DA12-8 300 38.1 25.4 44 55 2100 320

Ratchet Adapter for Torque Wrench Testers RoHS

Ratchet Adapter
RA2 • Rotates wrench to proper testing position on tester
• Gear action 3.75
Dimensions [mm] Capacity Weight
Model
Sq. Drive (Male) Sq. Drive (Female) Height Outside Dia. [N·m] [kg]
RA3mk2 9.5 9.5 37.3 55 70 0.28
RA4mk2 12.7 12.7 52.5 70 220 0.6
RA6mk2 19 19 69.3 115 850 2.3
RA8mk2 25.4 25.4 92.8 161 2100 6.3
RA12 38.1 38.1 111 234 3000 12.6

EVERTORQUE • For repairs of torque wrenches and torque screwdrivers


Model
EVERTORQUE
Part #
830
Lubricant for repair RoHS Evertorque Application List
Applicable Model Applicable Part
QL/QLE/CLE/PQL/PCL/YCL Thrustring; Steel Ball, Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread
Click Type Torque Wrench WQL Thrustring; Steel Ball, Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread, Knob, Protector; Joint
MPQL Thrustring; Steel Ball, Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread, Ratchet, Marker Pipe; Joint
RTD, RNTD Main Shaft, Toggle Sheet; Serration
Click Type Torque Screwdriver RTD, LTD, BMLD Case, Adjusting Piece; Serration
Semi-Automatic Airtork A/AC Thrustring; Steel Ball, Scale Piece, Adjusting Screw; Thread
Fully-Automatic Airtork AP, AS
Fully-Automatic Electric Nutrunner DAP Reduction Clutch; Clutch
Multiple Unit MC, ME, DCME

65
Torque Settings for Torque Screwdrivers
■ LTD, RTD, MLD Bit

Method of setting torque, Adjustable type: Coupler


1. Turn the locker of the main unit clockwise to release the lock.
2. Holding the main scale knurling part with the fingers of your right
Knurling
hand, turn the grip with the fingers of your left hand to set the (Scale plate)
Technical Data

120
torque value. Main scale
110
90 100

* Setting the torque set values:


2 1 0
Supplemental graduation 4 3
(1) Turn the grip to match the top end of the supplemental L
graduation with the main scale. Locker o
c
(2) Match the supplemental graduation line with the main scale k
Lock point
vertical line (See the figure below).
3. After setting the torque, turn the main unit locker Grip
counterclockwise to lock it. Ex. 82 cN·m

■ NTD, RNTD Coupler Bit


Method of setting torque, Preset type:
Adjusting bar
1. Holding the grip with your left hand, insert the adjusting tool bar
into the grooves of the adjustment screw and turn to adjust. Turn
clockwise to increase the torque value.
2. Insert with the exclusive bit into the loading device of the Torque
Driver Tester (TDT) and fix it.
Increase
3. Turn the loading device clockwise to measure the torque value.
4. Continue to repeat procedures 1-3 until the torque is matched.
Grip Adjusting screw

■ FTD50-400CN
Method of preloading the FTD
Grip
The preload function is a function that uses the handle to apply a
preloading torque close to that of the measuring point to minimize
the twisting angle during measurement. Scale plate
In the FTD series torque screwdrivers, a preload function is Needle
provided to prevent your wrist from becoming strained and the
torque scale from becoming difficult to read when operating close
to the maximum torque.
1. Holding the FTD screwdriver with your left hand, turn the R L
preload handle in the counterclockwise direction using the FREE

fingers of your right hand (in case of clockwise measuring).


2. After some slipping turns, the needle will begin to move, and it
will be easy to set an optional torque value.
3. If you do not wish to use the preload function, turn the preload Set indicator Handle
handle until there is no tension and the central set indicator (red
mark) points to the FREE mark.

■ FTD-S 0 Needle

Method of setting the FTD-S indicator and memory pointer


1. Make sure the indicator is pointing to zero by matching the scale.
If not, adjust to zero by lightly pushing down on the scale and
rotating it.
2. Turn the memory pointer in the direction opposite to the
measuring direction until it matches the main indicator.
3. Carry out torque measurement or torque tightening. Memory pointer

66
Torque Settings for Torque Wrenches
Adjuster

■ Adjustable type Grip End Cap

● QL, QL5/CL, CL5 1


1. Turn the adjuster and match up the mark of the adjuster
and mark of grip-end cap.
2
2. Pull the adjuster.

Technical Data
3. Pull the adjuster and turn it to set a torque.

Torque increase

Torque decrease

● QL, CL, YCL, A, etc. Main scale window


Supplemental graduation
window Locker
1. Release the locker and turn it counterclockwise. Down
2. Set the torque by turning the supplemental graduation,
confirming the value of the main scale.
LOCK
N・m

0
20
40
3. Turn the locker clockwise to lock it. Change the locker pin
Up
location if the pin is contacted when locking.

Supplemental
Main scale Basic line graduation Spring pin

Main Graduation
● QLE2, CLE2, DQLE2, and PHLE2 Supplemental Graduation
1. Press the push button Push button
Main scale window
2. Remove the extension handle Supplemental graduation window
3. Turning the adjusting handle clockwise to increase the set 1 Push button

torque and counterclockwise to reduce it.


Adjusting handle
2

Torque increase
Extension handle

3
Torque Decrease

Main scale window Supplemental graduation window


■ Pre-lock and preset types
● PQL, PCL, AC2, QSP3, etc. Down
1. Insert the provided hexagon key into the adjusting hexagonal hole. N・m
500

600

700

2. Turn the hexagon key to set the torque, confirming the value on the Up
main scale and supplemental graduation.
3. No locking mechanism is needed for PQL models (An adjusting tool
for QSP3 is optional). Supplemental Hexagon key
Basic line graduation
Model Adjusting hexagon hole mm size across flats

PQL6N4-PQL25N 2.5
PQL50N-200N4
4
AC25N2-100N2

■ Dial Indication types 0 0


50
50

50

● DB, CDB, T
1. For measurement
The scale on the dial gauge can be rotated. Press the dial case from above
and turn the pointer to correctly match “0”.
2. Presetting exclusively for tightening Glass plate
Alternatively, the desired torque can be preset on the dial beforehand and 0

then the bolt can be tightened until the pointer shows “0”.

67
Torque Conversion List
kgf·cm kgf·cm
kgf·m N·m N·m 1kgf·cm=0.0980665N·m
1kgf·m=9.80665N·m
kgf·m 1N·m=10.1972kgf·cm
1N·m=0.101972kgf·m
N·m kgf·cm
kgf·cm 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 N·m 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9
10 0.981 1.08 1.18 1.27 1.37 1.47 1.57 1.67 1.77 1.86 1 10.2 11.2 12.2 13.3 14.3 15.3 16.3 17.3 18.4 19.4
20 1.96 2.06 2.16 2.26 2.35 2.45 2.55 2.65 2.75 2.84 2 20.4 21.4 22.4 23.5 24.5 25.5 26.5 27.5 28.6 29.6
Technical Data

30 2.94 3.04 3.14 3.24 3.33 3.43 3.53 3.63 3.73 3.82 3 30.6 31.6 32.6 33.7 34.7 35.7 36.7 37.7 38.7 39.8
40 3.92 4.02 4.12 4.22 4.31 4.41 4.51 4.61 4.71 4.81 4 40.8 41.8 42.8 43.8 44.9 45.9 46.9 47.9 48.9 50.0
50 4.90 5.00 5.10 5.20 5.30 5.39 5.49 5.59 5.69 5.79 5 51.0 52.0 53.0 54.0 55.1 56.1 57.1 58.1 59.1 60.2
60 5.88 5.98 6.08 6.18 6.28 6.37 6.47 6.57 6.67 6.77 6 61.2 62.2 63.2 64.2 65.3 66.3 67.3 68.3 69.3 70.4
70 6.86 6.96 7.06 7.16 7.26 7.35 7.45 7.55 7.65 7.75 7 71.4 72.4 73.4 74.4 75.5 76.5 77.5 78.5 79.5 80.6
80 7.85 7.94 8.04 8.14 8.24 8.34 8.43 8.53 8.63 8.73 8 81.6 82.6 83.6 84.6 85.7 86.7 87.7 88.7 89.7 90.8
90 8.83 8.92 9.02 9.12 9.22 9.32 9.41 9.51 9.61 9.71 9 91.8 92.8 93.8 94.8 95.9 96.9 97.9 98.9 99.9 101
100 9.81 9.90 10.0 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111

N·m kgf·m
kgf·cm 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 N·m 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
100 9.81 10.8 11.8 12.7 13.7 14.7 15.7 16.7 17.7 18.6 10 1.02 1.12 1.22 1.33 1.43 1.53 1.63 1.73 1.84 1.94
200 19.6 20.6 21.6 22.6 23.5 24.5 25.5 26.5 27.5 28.4 20 2.04 2.14 2.24 2.35 2.45 2.55 2.65 2.75 2.86 2.96
300 29.4 30.4 31.4 32.4 33.3 34.3 35.3 36.3 37.3 38.2 30 3.06 3.16 3.26 3.37 3.47 3.57 3.67 3.77 3.87 3.98
400 39.2 40.2 41.2 42.2 43.1 44.1 45.1 46.1 47.1 48.1 40 4.08 4.18 4.28 4.38 4.49 4.59 4.69 4.79 4.89 5.00
500 49.0 50.0 51.0 52.0 53.0 53.9 54.9 55.9 56.9 57.9 50 5.10 5.20 5.30 5.40 5.51 5.61 5.71 5.81 5.91 6.02
600 58.8 59.8 60.8 61.8 62.8 63.7 64.7 65.7 66.7 67.7 60 6.12 6.22 6.32 6.42 6.53 6.63 6.73 6.83 6.93 7.04
700 68.6 69.6 70.6 71.6 72.6 73.5 74.5 75.5 76.5 77.5 70 7.14 7.24 7.34 7.44 7.55 7.65 7.75 7.85 7.95 8.06
800 78.5 79.4 80.4 81.4 82.4 83.4 84.3 85.3 86.3 87.3 80 8.16 8.26 8.36 8.46 8.57 8.67 8.77 8.87 8.97 9.08
900 88.3 89.2 90.2 91.2 92.2 93.2 94.1 95.1 96.1 97.1 90 9.18 9.28 9.38 9.48 9.59 9.69 9.79 9.89 9.99 10.1
1000 98.1 99.0 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 100 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 11.0 11.1

N·m kgf·m
kgf·m 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 N·m 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
10 98.1 108 118 127 137 147 157 167 177 186 100 10.2 11.2 12.2 13.3 14.3 15.3 16.3 17.3 18.4 19.4
20 196 206 216 226 235 245 255 265 275 284 200 20.4 21.4 22.4 23.5 24.5 25.5 26.5 27.5 28.6 29.6
30 294 304 314 324 333 343 353 363 373 382 300 30.6 31.6 32.6 33.7 34.7 35.7 36.7 37.7 38.7 39.8
40 392 402 412 422 431 441 451 461 471 481 400 40.8 41.8 42.8 43.8 44.9 45.9 46.9 47.9 48.9 50.0
50 490 500 510 520 530 539 549 559 569 579 500 51.0 52.0 53.0 54.0 55.1 56.1 57.1 58.1 59.1 60.2
60 588 598 608 618 628 637 647 657 667 677 600 61.2 62.2 63.2 64.2 65.3 66.3 67.3 68.3 69.3 70.4
70 686 696 706 716 726 735 745 755 765 775 700 71.4 72.4 73.4 74.4 75.5 76.5 77.5 78.5 79.5 80.6
80 785 794 804 814 824 834 843 853 863 873 800 81.6 82.6 83.6 84.6 85.7 86.7 87.7 88.7 89.7 90.8
90 883 892 902 912 922 932 941 951 961 971 900 91.8 92.8 93.8 94.8 95.9 96.9 97.9 98.9 99.9 101
100 981 990 1000 1010 1020 1030 1040 1050 1060 1070 1000 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111

■ Unit of Torque and Conversion Values


S.I. unit system Metric unit system American unit system
mN·m cN·m N·m gf·cm kgf·cm kgf·m ozf·in lbf·in lbf・ft
1 mN・m = 1 0.10 0.001 10.2 0.0102 0.000102 0.142 0.00885 0.000738
1 cN・m = 10 1 0.01 102 0.102 0.00102 1.42 0.0885 0.00738
1 N・m = 1000 100 1 10200 10.2 0.102 142 8.85 0.738
1 gf・cm = 0.0981 0.00981 0.0000981 1 0.001 0.00001 0.0139 0.000868 0.0000723
1 kgf・cm = 98.1 9.81 0.0981 1000 1 0.01 13.9 0.868 0.0723
1 kgf・m = 9810 981 9.81 100000 100 1 1390 86.8 7.23
1 ozf・in = 7.06 0.706 0.00706 72.0 0.072 0.00072 1 0.0625 0.00521
1 lbf・in = 113 11.3 0.113 1150 1.15 0.0115 16 1 0.0833
1 lbf・ft = 1360 136 1.36 13800 13.8 0.138 192 12 1
Country/Region Japan, China, Europe Asia U.S.A., Aircraft industry
1 [N·m] = 10.1972 [kgf·cm] ≈ 10.20 [kgf·cm] 1 [kgf·cm] = 0.0980665 [N·m] ≈ 0.0981 [N·m]
Conversion example: T = 25·0 [kgf·cm] = 25.0 × 0.0980665 = 2.4516625 [N·m] ≈ 2.45 [N·m]

JCSS/Japan Calibration Service System


Tohnichi Mfg. Co. Ltd’s torque standards calibration laboratory is now an authorized calibration service provider of
JCSS/Japan Calibration Service System under Japanese measurement law. Registration number: JCSS0281
Based on this, Tohnichi has launched a JCSS calibration service for DOTE3-G torque wrench testers from 10 N·m to 1000
N·m as a validated JCSS system and an uncertainty certificate service for outside of the above stated torque range.
Tohnichi issued JCSS calibration certificate is recognized internationally based on MRA/Mutual Recognition
Arrangement of ILAC/International Laboratory Accreditation Cooperation and APLAC/Asia Pacifi c Laboratory
Accreditation Cooperation by IAJapan/International Accreditation Japan.

68
Standard Tightening Torque
Standard tightening torque [N·m] Reference value Standard tightening torque [kgf·cm] Reference value

Nominal diameter T 0.5T series 1.8T series 2.4T series Nominal diameter T 0.5T series 1.8T series 2.4T series
[N·m] [N·m] [N.m] [N.m] [kgf.cm] [kgf.cm] [kgf.cm] [kgf.cm]
M1 0.0195 0.0098 0.035 0.047 M1 0.199 0.100 0.357 0.479
(M1.1) 0.027 0.0135 0.049 0.065 (M1.1) 0.275 0.138 0.500 0.663
M1.2 0.037 0.0185 0.066 0.088 M1.2 0.377 0.189 0.673 0.897
(M1.4) 0.058 0.029 0.104 0.140 (M1.4) 0.591 0.296 1.06 1.43
M1.6 0.086 0.043 0.156 0.206 M1.6 0.877 0.438 1.59 2.10
(M1.8) 0.128 0.064 0.23 0.305 (M1.8) 1.31 0.653 2.35 3.11
M2 0.176 0.088 0.315 0.42 M2 1.79 0.897 3.21 4.28
(M2.2) 0.23 0.116 0.41 0.55 (M2.2) 2.35 1.17 4.18 5.61

Technical Data
M2.5 0.36 0.18 0.65 0.86 M2.5 3.67 1.84 6.63 8.77
M3 0.63 0.315 1.14 1.50 M3 6.42 3.21 11.6 15.3
(M3.5) 1 0.5 1.8 2.40 (M3.5) 10.2 5.1 18.4 24.5
M4 1.5 0.75 2.7 3.6 M4 15.3 7.6 27.5 36.7
(M4.5) 2.15 1.08 3.9 5.2 (M4.5) 21.9 11.0 39.8 53.0
M5 3 1.5 5.4 7.2 M5 29.4 14.7 53.0 70.6
M6 5.2 2.6 9.2 12.2 M6 53.0 26.5 93.8 124
(M7) 8.4 4.2 15 20.0 (M7) 85.7 42.8 153 204
M8 12.5 6.2 22 29.5 M8 127 63.2 224 301
M10 24.5 12.5 44 59 M10 250 127 449 602
M12 42 21 76 100 M12 428 214 775 1020
(M14) 68 34 122 166 (M14) 693 347 1240 1690
M16 106 53 190 255 M16 1080 540 1940 2600
M18 146 73 270 350 M18 1490 744 2750 3570
M20 204 102 370 490 M20 2080 1040 3770 5000
(M22) 282 140 500 670 (M22) 2880 1430 5100 6830
M24 360 180 650 860 M24 3670 1840 6630 8770
(M27) 520 260 940 1240 (M27) 5300 2650 9590 12600
M30 700 350 1260 1700 M30 7140 3570 12800 17300
(M33) 960 480 1750 2300 (M33) 9790 4890 17800 23500
M36 1240 620 2250 3000 M36 12600 6320 22900 30600
(M39) 1600 800 2900 3800 (M39) 16300 8160 29600 38700
M42 2000 1000 3600 4800 M42 20400 10200 36700 48900
(M45) 2500 1260 4500 6000 (M45) 25500 12800 45900 61200
M48 2950 1500 5300 7000 M48 30100 15300 54000 71400
(M52) 3800 1900 6800 9200 (M52) 38700 19400 69300 93800
M56 4800 2400 8600 11600 M56 48900 24500 87700 118000
(M60) 5900 2950 10600 14000 (M60) 60200 30100 108000 143000
M64 7200 3600 13000 17500 M64 73400 36700 133000 178000
(M68) 8800 4400 16000 21000 (M68) 89700 44900 163000 214000
Standard bolt stress: 210 [ N/mm2 ] Stress area of bolt (JIS B 1082) Note: Conversion values rolled up to effective 3-digits.

■ Screws and Applicable “T” Series


Standard T series 0.5T series 1.8T series 2.4T series
Applicable screws 4.6-6.8 - 8.8-12.9 10.9-12.9
(Strengths) (Material) SS, SC, SUS Brass, Copper, Aluminum SCr, SNC, SCM SCr, SNC, SCM, SNCM
Axial tension standard value 210 105 380 500
[N/mm2] Min - Max 300-160 150-80 540-290 710-380
To be applied to ordinary Male and female screws with
Durable screw joints made of special steel including those
Application screws, unless otherwise copper, aluminum or plastic,
affected by additional dynamic loads (Friction clamping)
specified for die-cast plastic products
Applicable products Ordinary products Electronic products Vehicles, Engines Construction products
* The maximum to the minimum of the axial stress is considered as the dispersion of the torque coefficient.
Example: max = 210 × (0.2/0.14) = 300 [N/mm2]
Torque coefficient: 0.14/Min. - 0.2/Avg. - 0.26/Max.

Calibration Certificate
● Torque wrenches are measuring instruments. The calibration certificate is the document which certifies
the accuracy of the torque products, which are traceable to Japanese national standards. Please keep the
calibration certificate for future use.
● Accuracy % is calculated on each indicated value. Accuracy stated as “+/- a percentage + 1 digit” indicates
that digital display will round up to next digit in resolution if value falls between digits.
● Tohnichi’s torque products provided with a calibration certificate can be used immediately at ISO9000 facilities
without the need for further acceptance inspection or any additional certifications.
● The calibration certificate is effective for 1 year from the date of first use within 3 years from the date of
inspection. Please fill in the date in the calibration certificate when first used.
● Tohnichi’s manual torque tools are normally guaranteed to 100,000 tightening cycles or 1 year. For click type
torque wrenches, it can be also used up to 1,000,000 tightening cycles if the function is properly maintained
and adjusted at every 100,000 cycles.

RoHS/Restriction of Hazardous Substances Directive


Following RoHS, which restricts the use of certain hazardous materials in product manufacturing, Tohnichi has
expanded its efforts in environmentally friendly procurement. Starting with our Product Catalog 2011 edition,
the RoH
RoHS mark is shown on all applicable models conforming to the RoHS directive. For details, please contact
Tohnichi.

69
TOHNICHI MFG. CO., LTD.
2-12, Omori-Kita 2-Chome, Ota-Ku, Tokyo 143-0016, Japan
TEL:+81-3-3762-2455 FAX:+81-3-3761-3852
E-mail : overseas@tohnichi.co.jp
URL : http://tohnichi.jp/english/index.html
N.V. TOHNICHI EUROPE S.A.
Industrieweg 27, Boortmeerbeek, B-3190 Belgium
TEL:+32 16 60 66 61 FAX:+32 16 60 66 75
E-mail : tohnichi-europe@online.be
URL : http://www.tohnichi.be
TOHNICHI MFG. CO., LTD. - Stuttgart Liaison Office
Konrad-Zuse-Platz 1, 71034 Boblingen, Germany
TEL:+49 7031 306 973 192 FAX:+49 7031 306 973 200
TOHNICHI AMERICA CORP.
1303 Barclay Blvd. Buffalo Grove, IL 60089 USA
TEL:+1 847 947 8560 FAX:+1 847 947 8572
E-mail : inquiry@tohnichi.com
URL : http://www.tohnichi.com
TOHNICHI AMERICA. - Atlanta Office
4046 Hwy 154 Suite 103 Newnan, GA 30265 USA
TEL:+1 678 423 5777 FAX:+1 678 423 1333
TOHNICHI SALES SHANGHAI CO., LTD.
Rm. 5 No. 99 Nong 1919 Du Hui Road Minhang. Shanghai. P. R. China
TEL:+86 21 3407 4008 FAX:+86 21 3407 4135
E-mail : sales@tohnichi-sh.com
URL : http://www.tohnichi-sh.com/

Designs and specifications are subject to change without notice.

The TUD symbol indicates that our products are ergonomically


designed and adapted for Color Vision Deficiencies.

16.04.10000

You might also like